* src/sh/ffi.c (ffi_prep_closure_loc): Don't ASSERT ABI test,
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / expr.c
blob59b76a4b5f5cc2811e00cfd280cf4b2c2644e7e8
1 /* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
2 Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
3 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011,
4 2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6 This file is part of GCC.
8 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
9 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
10 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
11 version.
13 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
14 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
15 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
16 for more details.
18 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
20 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
22 #include "config.h"
23 #include "system.h"
24 #include "coretypes.h"
25 #include "tm.h"
26 #include "machmode.h"
27 #include "rtl.h"
28 #include "tree.h"
29 #include "flags.h"
30 #include "regs.h"
31 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
32 #include "except.h"
33 #include "function.h"
34 #include "insn-config.h"
35 #include "insn-attr.h"
36 /* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
37 #include "expr.h"
38 #include "optabs.h"
39 #include "libfuncs.h"
40 #include "recog.h"
41 #include "reload.h"
42 #include "output.h"
43 #include "typeclass.h"
44 #include "toplev.h"
45 #include "langhooks.h"
46 #include "intl.h"
47 #include "tm_p.h"
48 #include "tree-iterator.h"
49 #include "tree-pass.h"
50 #include "tree-flow.h"
51 #include "target.h"
52 #include "common/common-target.h"
53 #include "timevar.h"
54 #include "df.h"
55 #include "diagnostic.h"
56 #include "ssaexpand.h"
57 #include "target-globals.h"
58 #include "params.h"
60 /* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
61 from first to last or from last to first.
63 They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
64 only if we have push insns. */
66 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
68 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
69 #if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
70 #define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
71 #endif
72 #endif
74 #endif
76 #ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
77 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
78 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
79 #else
80 #define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
81 #endif
82 #endif
85 /* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
86 around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
87 output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
88 indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
89 if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
90 the same indirect address eventually. */
91 int cse_not_expected;
93 /* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
94 be performed. */
95 struct move_by_pieces_d
97 rtx to;
98 rtx to_addr;
99 int autinc_to;
100 int explicit_inc_to;
101 rtx from;
102 rtx from_addr;
103 int autinc_from;
104 int explicit_inc_from;
105 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
106 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
107 int reverse;
110 /* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
111 be performed. */
113 struct store_by_pieces_d
115 rtx to;
116 rtx to_addr;
117 int autinc_to;
118 int explicit_inc_to;
119 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
120 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
121 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
122 void *constfundata;
123 int reverse;
126 static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
127 struct move_by_pieces_d *);
128 static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
129 static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
130 static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
131 static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
132 static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
133 static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
134 static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *, unsigned int);
135 static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
136 struct store_by_pieces_d *);
137 static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
138 static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
139 static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
140 static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
141 HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
142 tree, tree, int, alias_set_type);
143 static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
144 static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT,
145 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
146 enum machine_mode,
147 tree, tree, alias_set_type, bool);
149 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree, const_tree);
151 static int is_aligning_offset (const_tree, const_tree);
152 static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
153 enum expand_modifier);
154 static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
155 static rtx do_store_flag (sepops, rtx, enum machine_mode);
156 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
157 static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
158 #endif
159 static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
160 static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
161 static void write_complex_part (rtx, rtx, bool);
163 /* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
164 to perform a structure copy. */
165 #ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
166 #define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
167 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
168 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
169 #endif
171 /* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
172 called to clear storage. */
173 #ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
174 #define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
175 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
176 < (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
177 #endif
179 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
180 called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero. */
181 #ifndef SET_BY_PIECES_P
182 #define SET_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
183 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
184 < (unsigned int) SET_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
185 #endif
187 /* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
188 called to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
189 #ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
190 #define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
191 (move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
192 < (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO (optimize_insn_for_speed_p ()))
193 #endif
195 /* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
197 #ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
198 #define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
199 #endif
201 /* This is run to set up which modes can be used
202 directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. It is run
203 at the beginning of compilation and when the target is reinitialized. */
205 void
206 init_expr_target (void)
208 rtx insn, pat;
209 enum machine_mode mode;
210 int num_clobbers;
211 rtx mem, mem1;
212 rtx reg;
214 /* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
215 It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
216 With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
217 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
218 mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
220 /* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
221 useless RTL allocations. */
222 reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
224 insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
225 pat = gen_rtx_SET (VOIDmode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
226 PATTERN (insn) = pat;
228 for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
229 mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
231 int regno;
233 direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
234 PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
235 PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
236 PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
238 /* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
239 directly loaded or stored from memory. */
241 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
242 for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
243 && (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
244 regno++)
246 if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
247 continue;
249 SET_REGNO (reg, regno);
251 SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
252 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
253 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
254 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
256 SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
257 SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
258 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
259 direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
261 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
262 SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
263 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
264 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
266 SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
267 SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
268 if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
269 direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
273 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
275 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
276 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
278 enum machine_mode srcmode;
279 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
280 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
282 enum insn_code ic;
284 ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
285 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
286 continue;
288 PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
290 if (insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, mem))
291 float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
296 /* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
298 void
299 init_expr (void)
301 memset (&crtl->expr, 0, sizeof (crtl->expr));
304 /* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
305 Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating, or both may be
306 fixed-point.
307 UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
308 This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
310 void
311 convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
313 enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
314 enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
315 int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
316 int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
317 enum insn_code code;
318 rtx libcall;
320 /* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
321 enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
322 : (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
325 gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
326 gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
327 gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
329 /* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
330 nothing to do. */
331 if (to == from)
332 return;
334 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
335 the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
336 TO here. */
338 if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
339 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
340 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
341 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
342 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
344 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
346 if (to_mode == from_mode
347 || (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
349 emit_move_insn (to, from);
350 return;
353 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
355 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
357 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
358 from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
359 else
360 to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
362 emit_move_insn (to, from);
363 return;
366 if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
368 convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
369 convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
370 return;
373 if (to_real)
375 rtx value, insns;
376 convert_optab tab;
378 gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
379 != GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
380 || (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
381 != DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
383 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
384 /* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
385 tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
386 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
387 tab = sext_optab;
388 else
389 tab = trunc_optab;
391 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
393 code = convert_optab_handler (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
394 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
396 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
397 tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
398 return;
401 /* Otherwise use a libcall. */
402 libcall = convert_optab_libfunc (tab, to_mode, from_mode);
404 /* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
405 gcc_assert (libcall);
407 start_sequence ();
408 value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
409 1, from, from_mode);
410 insns = get_insns ();
411 end_sequence ();
412 emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
413 tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
414 from)
415 : gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
416 return;
419 /* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
420 /* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
421 xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
422 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
424 enum machine_mode full_mode
425 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
427 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode)
428 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
430 if (full_mode != from_mode)
431 from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
432 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, full_mode),
433 to, from, UNKNOWN);
434 return;
436 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
438 rtx new_from;
439 enum machine_mode full_mode
440 = smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
442 gcc_assert (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode, from_mode)
443 != CODE_FOR_nothing);
445 if (to_mode == full_mode)
447 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode,
448 from_mode),
449 to, from, UNKNOWN);
450 return;
453 new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
454 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (sext_optab, full_mode, from_mode),
455 new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
457 /* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
458 from_mode = full_mode;
459 from = new_from;
462 /* Make sure both are fixed-point modes or both are not. */
463 gcc_assert (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode) ==
464 ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (to_mode));
465 if (ALL_SCALAR_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (from_mode))
467 /* If we widen from_mode to to_mode and they are in the same class,
468 we won't saturate the result.
469 Otherwise, always saturate the result to play safe. */
470 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode)
471 && GET_MODE_SIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
472 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 0);
473 else
474 expand_fixed_convert (to, from, 0, 1);
475 return;
478 /* Now both modes are integers. */
480 /* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
481 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
482 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
484 rtx insns;
485 rtx lowpart;
486 rtx fill_value;
487 rtx lowfrom;
488 int i;
489 enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
490 int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
492 /* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
493 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
494 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
496 /* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
497 so that we always generate the same set of insns for
498 better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
499 we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
500 if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
501 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
502 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
503 return;
505 /* Next, try converting via full word. */
506 else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
507 && ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
508 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
510 rtx word_to = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
511 if (REG_P (to))
513 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
514 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
515 emit_clobber (to);
517 convert_move (word_to, from, unsignedp);
518 emit_unop_insn (code, to, word_to, equiv_code);
519 return;
522 /* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
523 start_sequence ();
525 /* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
526 that the source does not overlap the target. */
528 if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
529 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
531 /* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
532 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
533 lowpart_mode = word_mode;
534 else
535 lowpart_mode = from_mode;
537 lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
539 lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
540 emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
542 /* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
543 if (unsignedp)
544 fill_value = const0_rtx;
545 else
546 fill_value = emit_store_flag (gen_reg_rtx (word_mode),
547 LT, lowfrom, const0_rtx,
548 VOIDmode, 0, -1);
550 /* Fill the remaining words. */
551 for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
553 int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
554 rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
556 gcc_assert (subword);
558 if (fill_value != subword)
559 emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
562 insns = get_insns ();
563 end_sequence ();
565 emit_insn (insns);
566 return;
569 /* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
570 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
571 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
573 if (!((MEM_P (from)
574 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
575 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
576 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
577 || REG_P (from)
578 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
579 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
580 convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
581 return;
584 /* Now follow all the conversions between integers
585 no more than a word long. */
587 /* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
588 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
589 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, from_mode))
591 if (!((MEM_P (from)
592 && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
593 && direct_load[(int) to_mode]
594 && ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
595 || REG_P (from)
596 || GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
597 from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
598 if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
599 && ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
600 from = copy_to_reg (from);
601 emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
602 return;
605 /* Handle extension. */
606 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
608 /* Convert directly if that works. */
609 if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
610 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
612 emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
613 return;
615 else
617 enum machine_mode intermediate;
618 rtx tmp;
619 int shift_amount;
621 /* Search for a mode to convert via. */
622 for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
623 intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
624 if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
625 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
626 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
627 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (to_mode, intermediate)))
628 && (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
629 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
631 convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
632 unsignedp), unsignedp);
633 return;
636 /* No suitable intermediate mode.
637 Generate what we need with shifts. */
638 shift_amount = (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode)
639 - GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode));
640 from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
641 tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
642 to, unsignedp);
643 tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
644 to, unsignedp);
645 if (tmp != to)
646 emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
647 return;
651 /* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
652 if (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode,
653 from_mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
655 emit_unop_insn (convert_optab_handler (trunc_optab, to_mode, from_mode),
656 to, from, UNKNOWN);
657 return;
660 /* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
661 the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
662 and for which there was no special instruction.
664 ??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
665 mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
666 call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
667 if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode))
669 rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
670 emit_move_insn (to, temp);
671 return;
674 /* Mode combination is not recognized. */
675 gcc_unreachable ();
678 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
679 from converting X to mode MODE.
680 Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
681 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
682 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
683 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
686 convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
688 return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
691 /* Return an rtx for a value that would result
692 from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
693 Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
694 UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
696 This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
697 or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
699 You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
702 convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
704 rtx temp;
706 /* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
707 the required extension, strip it. */
709 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
710 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
711 && SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
712 x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
714 if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
715 oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
717 if (mode == oldmode)
718 return x;
720 /* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
721 a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
722 we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
723 the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
724 make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
726 if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
727 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
728 && CONST_INT_P (x) && INTVAL (x) < 0)
730 double_int val = uhwi_to_double_int (INTVAL (x));
732 /* We need to zero extend VAL. */
733 if (oldmode != VOIDmode)
734 val = double_int_zext (val, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
736 return immed_double_int_const (val, mode);
739 /* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
740 are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
741 non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
742 wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
744 if ((CONST_INT_P (x)
745 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
746 || (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
747 && GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
748 && (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
749 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode)
750 && ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
751 && direct_load[(int) mode])
752 || (REG_P (x)
753 && (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
754 || HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
755 && TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION_MODES_P (mode,
756 GET_MODE (x))))))))
758 /* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
759 X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
760 the case, but it's the best we can do. */
761 if (CONST_INT_P (x) && oldmode != VOIDmode
762 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > GET_MODE_PRECISION (oldmode))
764 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
766 /* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
767 zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
768 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
769 if (! unsignedp
770 && val_signbit_known_set_p (oldmode, val))
771 val |= ~GET_MODE_MASK (oldmode);
773 return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
776 return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
779 /* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
780 subreg operation. */
781 if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
783 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
784 return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
787 temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
788 convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
789 return temp;
792 /* Return the largest alignment we can use for doing a move (or store)
793 of MAX_PIECES. ALIGN is the largest alignment we could use. */
795 static unsigned int
796 alignment_for_piecewise_move (unsigned int max_pieces, unsigned int align)
798 enum machine_mode tmode;
800 tmode = mode_for_size (max_pieces * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
801 if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
802 align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
803 else
805 enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
807 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
808 tmode != VOIDmode;
809 xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
810 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > max_pieces
811 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
812 break;
814 align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
817 return align;
820 /* Return the widest integer mode no wider than SIZE. If no such mode
821 can be found, return VOIDmode. */
823 static enum machine_mode
824 widest_int_mode_for_size (unsigned int size)
826 enum machine_mode tmode, mode = VOIDmode;
828 for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
829 tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
830 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < size)
831 mode = tmode;
833 return mode;
836 /* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
837 store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
838 MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
839 for an immediate constant. */
841 #define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
843 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
844 instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
845 succeed. */
848 can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
849 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
851 return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
854 /* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
855 block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
857 If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
858 used to push FROM to the stack.
860 ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
862 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
863 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
864 stpcpy. */
867 move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
868 unsigned int align, int endp)
870 struct move_by_pieces_d data;
871 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode, from_addr_mode
872 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (from));
873 rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
874 unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
875 enum insn_code icode;
877 align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
879 data.offset = 0;
880 data.from_addr = from_addr;
881 if (to)
883 to_addr_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to));
884 to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
885 data.to = to;
886 data.autinc_to
887 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
888 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
889 data.reverse
890 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
892 else
894 to_addr_mode = VOIDmode;
895 to_addr = NULL_RTX;
896 data.to = NULL_RTX;
897 data.autinc_to = 1;
898 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
899 data.reverse = 1;
900 #else
901 data.reverse = 0;
902 #endif
904 data.to_addr = to_addr;
905 data.from = from;
906 data.autinc_from
907 = (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
908 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
909 || GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
911 data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
912 data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
913 if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
914 data.len = len;
916 /* If copying requires more than two move insns,
917 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
918 and use post-increment if available. */
919 if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
920 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
922 /* Find the mode of the largest move...
923 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
924 USE_* macros below. */
925 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
926 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
928 if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
930 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode,
931 plus_constant (from_addr, len));
932 data.autinc_from = 1;
933 data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
935 if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
937 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
938 data.autinc_from = 1;
939 data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
941 if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
942 data.from_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (from_addr_mode, from_addr);
943 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
945 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
946 plus_constant (to_addr, len));
947 data.autinc_to = 1;
948 data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
950 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
952 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
953 data.autinc_to = 1;
954 data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
956 if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
957 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
960 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
962 /* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
963 successively smaller modes. */
965 while (max_size > 1)
967 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
969 if (mode == VOIDmode)
970 break;
972 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
973 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
974 move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
976 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
979 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
980 gcc_assert (!data.len);
982 if (endp)
984 rtx to1;
986 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
987 if (data.autinc_to)
989 if (endp == 2)
991 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
992 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
993 else
994 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
995 plus_constant (data.to_addr,
996 -1));
998 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
999 data.offset);
1001 else
1003 if (endp == 2)
1004 --data.offset;
1005 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
1007 return to1;
1009 else
1010 return data.to;
1013 /* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
1014 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
1016 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
1017 move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
1018 unsigned int max_size)
1020 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
1022 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, align);
1024 while (max_size > 1)
1026 enum machine_mode mode;
1027 enum insn_code icode;
1029 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
1031 if (mode == VOIDmode)
1032 break;
1034 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
1035 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1036 n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1038 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1041 gcc_assert (!l);
1042 return n_insns;
1045 /* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
1046 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
1047 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
1049 static void
1050 move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
1051 struct move_by_pieces_d *data)
1053 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1054 rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
1056 while (data->len >= size)
1058 if (data->reverse)
1059 data->offset -= size;
1061 if (data->to)
1063 if (data->autinc_to)
1064 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
1065 data->offset);
1066 else
1067 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
1070 if (data->autinc_from)
1071 from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
1072 data->offset);
1073 else
1074 from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
1076 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
1077 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
1078 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1079 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
1080 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
1081 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
1083 if (data->to)
1084 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
1085 else
1087 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
1088 emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
1089 #else
1090 gcc_unreachable ();
1091 #endif
1094 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
1095 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1096 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
1097 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
1099 if (! data->reverse)
1100 data->offset += size;
1102 data->len -= size;
1106 /* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
1107 string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
1108 or with a library call.
1110 Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
1111 SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
1112 ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
1113 METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
1115 Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
1116 0 otherwise. */
1119 emit_block_move_hints (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
1120 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1122 bool may_use_call;
1123 rtx retval = 0;
1124 unsigned int align;
1126 gcc_assert (size);
1127 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
1128 && INTVAL (size) == 0)
1129 return 0;
1131 switch (method)
1133 case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
1134 case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
1135 may_use_call = true;
1136 break;
1138 case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
1139 may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
1141 /* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
1142 to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
1143 NO_DEFER_POP;
1144 break;
1146 case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
1147 may_use_call = false;
1148 break;
1150 default:
1151 gcc_unreachable ();
1154 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y));
1155 align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
1156 gcc_assert (align >= BITS_PER_UNIT);
1158 /* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
1159 block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
1160 x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
1161 y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
1163 /* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
1164 can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
1165 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
1167 x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
1168 y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
1169 set_mem_size (x, INTVAL (size));
1170 set_mem_size (y, INTVAL (size));
1173 if (CONST_INT_P (size) && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
1174 move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
1175 else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align,
1176 expected_align, expected_size))
1178 else if (may_use_call
1179 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
1180 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
1182 /* Since x and y are passed to a libcall, mark the corresponding
1183 tree EXPR as addressable. */
1184 tree y_expr = MEM_EXPR (y);
1185 tree x_expr = MEM_EXPR (x);
1186 if (y_expr)
1187 mark_addressable (y_expr);
1188 if (x_expr)
1189 mark_addressable (x_expr);
1190 retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
1191 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
1194 else
1195 emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
1197 if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
1198 OK_DEFER_POP;
1200 return retval;
1204 emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
1206 return emit_block_move_hints (x, y, size, method, 0, -1);
1209 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
1210 block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
1211 already been placed on the stack. */
1213 static bool
1214 block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
1216 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1217 tree fn;
1218 #endif
1220 /* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
1221 if (PUSH_ARGS)
1222 return true;
1224 /* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
1225 an outgoing argument. */
1226 #if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
1227 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1228 /* Avoid set but not used warning if *REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE doesn't
1229 depend on its argument. */
1230 (void) fn;
1231 if (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE ((!fn ? NULL_TREE : TREE_TYPE (fn)))
1232 && REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
1233 return false;
1234 #endif
1236 /* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
1237 argument. */
1239 CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far_v;
1240 cumulative_args_t args_so_far;
1241 tree fn, arg;
1243 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
1244 INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far_v, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
1245 args_so_far = pack_cumulative_args (&args_so_far_v);
1247 arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
1248 for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
1250 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
1251 rtx tmp = targetm.calls.function_arg (args_so_far, mode,
1252 NULL_TREE, true);
1253 if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
1254 return false;
1255 if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
1256 return false;
1257 targetm.calls.function_arg_advance (args_so_far, mode,
1258 NULL_TREE, true);
1261 return true;
1264 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
1265 return true if successful. */
1267 static bool
1268 emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align,
1269 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
1271 int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
1272 enum machine_mode mode;
1274 if (expected_align < align)
1275 expected_align = align;
1277 /* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
1278 volatile_ok = 1;
1280 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
1281 including more than one in the machine description unless
1282 the more limited one has some advantage. */
1284 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
1285 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
1287 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (movmem_optab, mode);
1289 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
1290 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
1291 here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
1292 returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
1293 actual mode mask. */
1294 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
1295 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
1296 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
1297 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
1299 struct expand_operand ops[6];
1300 unsigned int nops;
1302 /* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
1303 nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
1304 that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
1305 emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
1306 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
1307 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
1309 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], x);
1310 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], y);
1311 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
1312 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[2], size, mode, true);
1313 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1314 if (nops == 6)
1316 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
1317 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
1319 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
1321 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1322 return true;
1327 volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
1328 return false;
1331 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
1332 Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
1335 emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
1337 rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
1338 tree call_expr, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
1339 enum machine_mode size_mode;
1340 rtx retval;
1342 /* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
1343 pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
1344 use them later. */
1346 dst_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (dst, 0));
1347 src_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (src, 0));
1349 dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
1350 src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
1352 dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
1353 src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
1355 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
1357 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
1358 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
1360 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
1361 memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
1362 the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
1363 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
1364 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
1366 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
1368 fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
1369 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, dst_tree, src_tree, size_tree);
1370 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
1372 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
1374 return retval;
1377 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
1378 for the function we use for block copies. The first time FOR_CALL
1379 is true, we call assemble_external. */
1381 static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
1383 void
1384 init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
1386 if (!block_move_fn)
1388 tree args, fn;
1390 fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
1391 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
1392 const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
1393 NULL_TREE);
1395 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
1396 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
1397 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
1398 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
1399 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
1400 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
1401 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
1403 block_move_fn = fn;
1406 if (asmspec)
1407 set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
1410 static tree
1411 emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
1413 static bool emitted_extern;
1415 if (!block_move_fn)
1416 init_block_move_fn (NULL);
1418 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
1420 emitted_extern = true;
1421 make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
1422 assemble_external (block_move_fn);
1425 return block_move_fn;
1428 /* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
1429 loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
1430 /* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
1432 static void
1433 emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
1434 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1436 rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
1437 enum machine_mode x_addr_mode
1438 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x));
1439 enum machine_mode y_addr_mode
1440 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y));
1441 enum machine_mode iter_mode;
1443 iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
1444 if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
1445 iter_mode = word_mode;
1447 top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1448 cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
1449 iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
1451 emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
1453 x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
1454 y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
1455 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
1457 emit_jump (cmp_label);
1458 emit_label (top_label);
1460 tmp = convert_modes (x_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1461 x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (x_addr_mode, x_addr, tmp);
1463 if (x_addr_mode != y_addr_mode)
1464 tmp = convert_modes (y_addr_mode, iter_mode, iter, true);
1465 y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (y_addr_mode, y_addr, tmp);
1467 x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
1468 y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
1470 emit_move_insn (x, y);
1472 tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
1473 true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
1474 if (tmp != iter)
1475 emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
1477 emit_label (cmp_label);
1479 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
1480 true, top_label);
1483 /* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
1484 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1486 void
1487 move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
1489 int i;
1490 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1491 rtx pat;
1492 rtx last;
1493 #endif
1495 if (nregs == 0)
1496 return;
1498 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
1499 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
1501 /* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
1502 #ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
1503 if (HAVE_load_multiple)
1505 last = get_last_insn ();
1506 pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
1507 GEN_INT (nregs));
1508 if (pat)
1510 emit_insn (pat);
1511 return;
1513 else
1514 delete_insns_since (last);
1516 #endif
1518 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1519 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
1520 operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
1523 /* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
1524 The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
1526 void
1527 move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
1529 int i;
1531 if (nregs == 0)
1532 return;
1534 /* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
1535 #ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
1536 if (HAVE_store_multiple)
1538 rtx last = get_last_insn ();
1539 rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
1540 GEN_INT (nregs));
1541 if (pat)
1543 emit_insn (pat);
1544 return;
1546 else
1547 delete_insns_since (last);
1549 #endif
1551 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
1553 rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
1555 gcc_assert (tem);
1557 emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
1561 /* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
1562 ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
1563 a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
1564 original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
1565 The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
1568 gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
1570 int i, length;
1571 rtx *tmps;
1573 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
1575 length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
1576 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, length);
1578 /* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
1579 i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
1581 if (i)
1582 tmps[0] = 0;
1584 for (; i < length; i++)
1586 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
1587 rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
1589 tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
1592 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
1595 /* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
1596 except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
1597 into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
1599 static void
1600 emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
1602 rtx src;
1603 int start, i;
1604 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
1606 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
1608 if (m != VOIDmode
1609 && !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1610 && !MEM_P (orig_src)
1611 && GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
1613 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1614 if (imode == BLKmode)
1615 src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize, 0);
1616 else
1617 src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1618 if (imode != BLKmode)
1619 src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
1620 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1621 /* ...and back again. */
1622 if (imode != BLKmode)
1623 src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
1624 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1625 return;
1628 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1629 both on the stack and in registers. */
1630 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
1631 start = 0;
1632 else
1633 start = 1;
1635 /* Process the pieces. */
1636 for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1638 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
1639 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
1640 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
1641 int shift = 0;
1643 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
1644 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
1646 /* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
1647 extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
1648 if (
1649 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
1650 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
1651 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
1652 #else
1653 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
1654 #endif
1656 shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
1657 bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
1658 gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
1661 /* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
1662 from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
1663 be loaded directly into the destination. */
1664 src = orig_src;
1665 if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
1666 && (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
1667 || (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
1668 && GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
1670 if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
1671 src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1672 else
1673 src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
1675 emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
1678 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
1679 if (MEM_P (src)
1680 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
1681 || MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
1682 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
1683 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1685 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
1686 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
1688 else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
1689 && GET_MODE (src) == mode
1690 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
1691 /* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
1692 tmps[i] = src;
1693 else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
1695 unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1696 unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
1698 if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
1699 || (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
1701 /* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
1702 have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
1703 can be used to determine the object and the bit field
1704 to be extracted. */
1705 tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
1706 if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
1707 && (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
1708 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1709 (bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1710 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1712 else
1714 rtx mem;
1716 gcc_assert (!bytepos);
1717 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1718 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1719 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1720 0, 1, false, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
1723 /* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
1724 SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
1725 to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
1726 else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
1727 && REG_P (src))
1729 int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
1730 rtx mem;
1732 mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
1733 emit_move_insn (mem, src);
1734 tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
1736 else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
1737 && XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
1738 tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
1739 else if (CONSTANT_P (src))
1741 HOST_WIDE_INT len = (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen;
1743 if (len == ssize)
1744 tmps[i] = src;
1745 else
1747 rtx first, second;
1749 gcc_assert (2 * len == ssize);
1750 split_double (src, &first, &second);
1751 if (i)
1752 tmps[i] = second;
1753 else
1754 tmps[i] = first;
1757 else if (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode)
1758 tmps[i] = src;
1759 else
1760 tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
1761 bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, false, NULL_RTX,
1762 mode, mode);
1764 if (shift)
1765 tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
1766 shift, tmps[i], 0);
1770 /* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
1771 where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1772 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
1773 if not known. */
1775 void
1776 emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1778 rtx *tmps;
1779 int i;
1781 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1782 emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
1784 /* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
1785 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
1787 rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
1788 if (d == NULL)
1789 continue;
1790 emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
1794 /* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
1795 PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
1796 in the right place. */
1799 emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
1801 rtvec vec;
1802 int i;
1804 vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
1805 emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
1807 /* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
1808 with the computed values. */
1809 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
1811 rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
1812 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1814 if (d)
1816 d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
1817 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
1819 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1822 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
1825 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
1826 non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
1828 void
1829 emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
1831 int i;
1833 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
1834 && GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
1835 && XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
1837 /* Skip first entry if NULL. */
1838 for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1839 emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
1840 XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
1843 /* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
1846 emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
1848 rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
1849 int i;
1851 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
1853 rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
1854 rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
1856 if (d)
1857 e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
1858 RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
1861 return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
1864 /* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
1865 where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
1866 SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
1867 known. */
1869 void
1870 emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
1872 rtx *tmps, dst;
1873 int start, finish, i;
1874 enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
1876 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
1878 if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
1879 && !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
1881 enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
1882 if (imode == BLKmode)
1883 dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize, 0);
1884 else
1885 dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
1886 emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
1887 if (imode != BLKmode)
1888 dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
1889 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
1890 return;
1893 /* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
1894 both on the stack and in registers. */
1895 if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
1896 start = 0;
1897 else
1898 start = 1;
1899 finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
1901 tmps = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, finish);
1903 /* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
1904 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1906 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
1907 if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1909 tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
1910 emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
1912 else
1913 tmps[i] = reg;
1916 /* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
1917 from strange tricks we might play. */
1918 dst = orig_dst;
1919 if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
1921 rtx temp;
1923 /* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
1924 a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
1925 so no action is necessary. */
1926 if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
1927 return;
1929 /* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
1930 it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
1931 the temporary. */
1933 temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
1934 emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
1935 emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
1936 return;
1938 else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
1940 enum machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
1941 enum machine_mode inner;
1942 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
1943 bool done = false;
1944 rtx temp;
1946 if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
1947 dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
1949 /* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
1950 /* If the first element of the vector is the low part
1951 of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
1952 initialize the destination. */
1953 if (start < finish)
1955 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
1956 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1957 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
1959 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
1960 inner, 0);
1961 if (temp)
1963 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1964 done = true;
1965 start++;
1970 /* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
1971 if (!done
1972 && start < finish - 1)
1974 inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
1975 bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
1976 if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
1978 temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
1979 inner, 0);
1980 if (temp)
1982 emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
1983 done = true;
1984 finish--;
1989 /* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
1990 if (!done)
1991 emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
1994 /* Process the pieces. */
1995 for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
1997 HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
1998 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
1999 unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2000 unsigned int adj_bytelen = bytelen;
2001 rtx dest = dst;
2003 /* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
2004 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2005 adj_bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
2007 if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
2009 if (bytepos + adj_bytelen
2010 <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2011 dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
2012 else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
2014 bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
2015 dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
2017 else
2019 enum machine_mode dest_mode = GET_MODE (dest);
2020 enum machine_mode tmp_mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
2022 gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
2024 if (GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (dest_mode)
2025 >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmp_mode))
2027 dest = assign_stack_temp (dest_mode,
2028 GET_MODE_SIZE (dest_mode),
2030 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest,
2031 tmp_mode,
2032 bytepos),
2033 tmps[i]);
2034 dst = dest;
2036 else
2038 dest = assign_stack_temp (tmp_mode,
2039 GET_MODE_SIZE (tmp_mode),
2041 emit_move_insn (dest, tmps[i]);
2042 dst = adjust_address (dest, dest_mode, bytepos);
2044 break;
2048 if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
2050 /* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
2051 Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
2052 if (
2053 #ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
2054 BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
2055 == (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
2056 #else
2057 BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2058 #endif
2061 int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2062 tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
2063 shift, tmps[i], 0);
2065 bytelen = adj_bytelen;
2068 /* Optimize the access just a bit. */
2069 if (MEM_P (dest)
2070 && (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
2071 || MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2072 && bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
2073 && bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2074 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
2075 else
2076 store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
2077 0, 0, mode, tmps[i]);
2080 /* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
2081 if (orig_dst != dst)
2082 emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
2085 /* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
2086 set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
2087 is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
2089 The purpose of this routine is to handle functions that return
2090 BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines (the PA for example)
2091 want to return all small structures in registers regardless of the
2092 structure's alignment. */
2095 copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
2097 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
2098 rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
2099 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
2100 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
2101 enum machine_mode copy_mode;
2103 if (tgtblk == 0)
2105 tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
2106 (TYPE_QUALS (type)
2107 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
2108 0, 1, 1);
2109 preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
2112 /* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
2113 into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
2115 if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
2116 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
2117 srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
2119 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
2120 SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
2121 set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
2123 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2124 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2125 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2126 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2127 end of the register. */
2128 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2129 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
2130 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2131 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2132 padding_correction
2133 = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2135 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. If the target lives in
2136 memory, take care of not reading/writing past its end by selecting
2137 a copy mode suited to BITSIZE. This should always be possible given
2138 how it is computed.
2140 We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
2141 strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
2142 time. */
2144 copy_mode = word_mode;
2145 if (MEM_P (tgtblk))
2147 enum machine_mode mem_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
2148 if (mem_mode != BLKmode)
2149 copy_mode = mem_mode;
2152 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2153 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2154 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2156 /* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
2157 word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2158 (the first time through). */
2159 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2160 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2161 src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
2162 GET_MODE (srcreg));
2164 /* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
2165 a word boundary. */
2166 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2167 dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
2169 /* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
2170 bitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
2171 store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 0, 0, copy_mode,
2172 extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
2173 xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2174 NULL_RTX, copy_mode, copy_mode));
2177 return tgtblk;
2180 /* Copy BLKmode value SRC into a register of mode MODE. Return the
2181 register if it contains any data, otherwise return null.
2183 This is used on targets that return BLKmode values in registers. */
2186 copy_blkmode_to_reg (enum machine_mode mode, tree src)
2188 int i, n_regs;
2189 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0, bytes;
2190 unsigned int bitsize;
2191 rtx *dst_words, dst, x, src_word = NULL_RTX, dst_word = NULL_RTX;
2192 enum machine_mode dst_mode;
2194 gcc_assert (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) == BLKmode);
2196 x = expand_normal (src);
2198 bytes = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (src));
2199 if (bytes == 0)
2200 return NULL_RTX;
2202 /* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see
2203 whether the register value should be padded on the left or on
2204 the right. Set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of padding
2205 bits needed on the left side.
2207 In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
2208 the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
2209 targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
2210 holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
2211 end of the register. */
2212 if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
2213 && (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (TREE_TYPE (src))
2214 ? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
2215 : BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
2216 padding_correction = (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD)
2217 * BITS_PER_UNIT));
2219 n_regs = (bytes + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
2220 dst_words = XALLOCAVEC (rtx, n_regs);
2221 bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (src)), BITS_PER_WORD);
2223 /* Copy the structure BITSIZE bits at a time. */
2224 for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
2225 bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
2226 bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
2228 /* We need a new destination pseudo each time xbitpos is
2229 on a word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
2230 (the first time through). */
2231 if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
2232 || xbitpos == padding_correction)
2234 /* Generate an appropriate register. */
2235 dst_word = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
2236 dst_words[xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD] = dst_word;
2238 /* Clear the destination before we move anything into it. */
2239 emit_move_insn (dst_word, CONST0_RTX (word_mode));
2242 /* We need a new source operand each time bitpos is on a word
2243 boundary. */
2244 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
2245 src_word = operand_subword_force (x, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, BLKmode);
2247 /* Use bitpos for the source extraction (left justified) and
2248 xbitpos for the destination store (right justified). */
2249 store_bit_field (dst_word, bitsize, xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD,
2250 0, 0, word_mode,
2251 extract_bit_field (src_word, bitsize,
2252 bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1, false,
2253 NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
2256 if (mode == BLKmode)
2258 /* Find the smallest integer mode large enough to hold the
2259 entire structure. */
2260 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
2261 mode != VOIDmode;
2262 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2263 /* Have we found a large enough mode? */
2264 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= bytes)
2265 break;
2267 /* A suitable mode should have been found. */
2268 gcc_assert (mode != VOIDmode);
2271 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
2272 dst_mode = word_mode;
2273 else
2274 dst_mode = mode;
2275 dst = gen_reg_rtx (dst_mode);
2277 for (i = 0; i < n_regs; i++)
2278 emit_move_insn (operand_subword (dst, i, 0, dst_mode), dst_words[i]);
2280 if (mode != dst_mode)
2281 dst = gen_lowpart (mode, dst);
2283 return dst;
2286 /* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
2287 to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
2289 void
2290 use_reg_mode (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg, enum machine_mode mode)
2292 gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2294 *call_fusage
2295 = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (mode, gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
2298 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
2299 starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
2301 void
2302 use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
2304 int i;
2306 gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
2308 for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
2309 use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
2312 /* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
2313 PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
2314 non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
2316 void
2317 use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
2319 int i;
2321 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
2323 rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
2325 /* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
2326 registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
2327 partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
2328 if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
2329 use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
2333 /* Return the defining gimple statement for SSA_NAME NAME if it is an
2334 assigment and the code of the expresion on the RHS is CODE. Return
2335 NULL otherwise. */
2337 static gimple
2338 get_def_for_expr (tree name, enum tree_code code)
2340 gimple def_stmt;
2342 if (TREE_CODE (name) != SSA_NAME)
2343 return NULL;
2345 def_stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (name);
2346 if (!def_stmt
2347 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (def_stmt) != code)
2348 return NULL;
2350 return def_stmt;
2354 /* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
2355 stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
2356 a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2357 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2358 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2359 Return nonzero if a call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
2362 can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2363 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2364 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp)
2366 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
2367 unsigned int max_size;
2368 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
2369 enum machine_mode mode;
2370 enum insn_code icode;
2371 int reverse;
2372 /* cst is set but not used if LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT doesn't use it. */
2373 rtx cst ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED;
2375 if (len == 0)
2376 return 1;
2378 if (! (memsetp
2379 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2380 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)))
2381 return 0;
2383 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2385 /* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2386 successively smaller modes. */
2388 for (reverse = 0;
2389 reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
2390 reverse++)
2392 l = len;
2393 max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2394 while (max_size > 1)
2396 mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2398 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2399 break;
2401 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2402 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
2403 && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2405 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2407 while (l >= size)
2409 if (reverse)
2410 offset -= size;
2412 cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
2413 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, cst))
2414 return 0;
2416 if (!reverse)
2417 offset += size;
2419 l -= size;
2423 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2426 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2427 gcc_assert (!l);
2430 return 1;
2433 /* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
2434 CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
2435 pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
2436 ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. MEMSETP is true if this is
2437 a memset operation and false if it's a copy of a constant string.
2438 If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
2439 mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
2440 stpcpy. */
2443 store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
2444 rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
2445 void *constfundata, unsigned int align, bool memsetp, int endp)
2447 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode
2448 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to));
2449 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2451 if (len == 0)
2453 gcc_assert (endp != 2);
2454 return to;
2457 gcc_assert (memsetp
2458 ? SET_BY_PIECES_P (len, align)
2459 : STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
2460 data.constfun = constfun;
2461 data.constfundata = constfundata;
2462 data.len = len;
2463 data.to = to;
2464 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2465 if (endp)
2467 rtx to1;
2469 gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
2470 if (data.autinc_to)
2472 if (endp == 2)
2474 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
2475 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
2476 else
2477 data.to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2478 plus_constant (data.to_addr,
2479 -1));
2481 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
2482 data.offset);
2484 else
2486 if (endp == 2)
2487 --data.offset;
2488 to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
2490 return to1;
2492 else
2493 return data.to;
2496 /* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2497 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2499 static void
2500 clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
2502 struct store_by_pieces_d data;
2504 if (len == 0)
2505 return;
2507 data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
2508 data.constfundata = NULL;
2509 data.len = len;
2510 data.to = to;
2511 store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
2514 /* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
2515 Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
2517 static rtx
2518 clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2519 HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2520 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2522 return const0_rtx;
2525 /* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
2526 Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
2527 rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
2529 static void
2530 store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces_d *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2531 unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2533 enum machine_mode to_addr_mode
2534 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (data->to));
2535 rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
2536 unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
2537 enum insn_code icode;
2539 data->offset = 0;
2540 data->to_addr = to_addr;
2541 data->autinc_to
2542 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
2543 || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2545 data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
2546 data->reverse
2547 = (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
2548 if (data->reverse)
2549 data->offset = data->len;
2551 /* If storing requires more than two move insns,
2552 copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
2553 and use post-increment if available. */
2554 if (!data->autinc_to
2555 && move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
2557 /* Determine the main mode we'll be using.
2558 MODE might not be used depending on the definitions of the
2559 USE_* macros below. */
2560 enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED
2561 = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2563 if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
2565 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode,
2566 plus_constant (to_addr, data->len));
2567 data->autinc_to = 1;
2568 data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
2571 if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
2572 && ! data->autinc_to)
2574 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2575 data->autinc_to = 1;
2576 data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
2579 if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
2580 data->to_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (to_addr_mode, to_addr);
2583 align = alignment_for_piecewise_move (STORE_MAX_PIECES, align);
2585 /* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
2586 successively smaller modes. */
2588 while (max_size > 1)
2590 enum machine_mode mode = widest_int_mode_for_size (max_size);
2592 if (mode == VOIDmode)
2593 break;
2595 icode = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
2596 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
2597 store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
2599 max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2602 /* The code above should have handled everything. */
2603 gcc_assert (!data->len);
2606 /* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
2607 with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
2608 to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
2610 static void
2611 store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
2612 struct store_by_pieces_d *data)
2614 unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
2615 rtx to1, cst;
2617 while (data->len >= size)
2619 if (data->reverse)
2620 data->offset -= size;
2622 if (data->autinc_to)
2623 to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
2624 data->offset);
2625 else
2626 to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
2628 if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
2629 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
2630 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
2632 cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
2633 emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
2635 if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
2636 emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
2638 if (! data->reverse)
2639 data->offset += size;
2641 data->len -= size;
2645 /* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
2646 its length in bytes. */
2649 clear_storage_hints (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method,
2650 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2652 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
2653 unsigned int align;
2655 gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2657 /* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
2658 just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
2659 if (mode != BLKmode
2660 && CONST_INT_P (size)
2661 && INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
2663 rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
2664 if (zero != NULL)
2666 emit_move_insn (object, zero);
2667 return NULL;
2670 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
2672 zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
2673 if (zero != NULL)
2675 write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
2676 write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
2677 return NULL;
2682 if (size == const0_rtx)
2683 return NULL;
2685 align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
2687 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
2688 && CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
2689 clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
2690 else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align,
2691 expected_align, expected_size))
2693 else if (ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (object)))
2694 return set_storage_via_libcall (object, size, const0_rtx,
2695 method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
2696 else
2697 gcc_unreachable ();
2699 return NULL;
2703 clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
2705 return clear_storage_hints (object, size, method, 0, -1);
2709 /* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
2710 Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
2713 set_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, bool tailcall)
2715 tree call_expr, fn, object_tree, size_tree, val_tree;
2716 enum machine_mode size_mode;
2717 rtx retval;
2719 /* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
2720 place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
2722 object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
2724 size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
2725 size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
2726 size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
2728 /* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
2729 memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
2730 the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
2731 targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
2732 for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
2734 object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
2735 if (!CONST_INT_P (val))
2736 val = convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (integer_type_node), val, 1);
2737 size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
2738 val_tree = make_tree (integer_type_node, val);
2740 fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
2741 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, object_tree, val_tree, size_tree);
2742 CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
2744 retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
2746 return retval;
2749 /* A subroutine of set_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
2750 for the function we use for block clears. The first time FOR_CALL
2751 is true, we call assemble_external. */
2753 tree block_clear_fn;
2755 void
2756 init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
2758 if (!block_clear_fn)
2760 tree fn, args;
2762 fn = get_identifier ("memset");
2763 args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
2764 integer_type_node, sizetype,
2765 NULL_TREE);
2767 fn = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
2768 DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
2769 TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
2770 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
2771 TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
2772 DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
2773 DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
2775 block_clear_fn = fn;
2778 if (asmspec)
2779 set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
2782 static tree
2783 clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
2785 static bool emitted_extern;
2787 if (!block_clear_fn)
2788 init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
2790 if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
2792 emitted_extern = true;
2793 make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
2794 assemble_external (block_clear_fn);
2797 return block_clear_fn;
2800 /* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
2802 bool
2803 set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align,
2804 unsigned int expected_align, HOST_WIDE_INT expected_size)
2806 /* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
2807 including more than one in the machine description unless
2808 the more limited one has some advantage. */
2810 enum machine_mode mode;
2812 if (expected_align < align)
2813 expected_align = align;
2815 for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
2816 mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
2818 enum insn_code code = direct_optab_handler (setmem_optab, mode);
2820 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
2821 /* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
2822 BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
2823 the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
2824 definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
2825 && ((CONST_INT_P (size)
2826 && ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
2827 <= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
2828 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD))
2830 struct expand_operand ops[6];
2831 unsigned int nops;
2833 nops = insn_data[(int) code].n_generator_args;
2834 gcc_assert (nops == 4 || nops == 6);
2836 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], object);
2837 /* The check above guarantees that this size conversion is valid. */
2838 create_convert_operand_to (&ops[1], size, mode, true);
2839 create_convert_operand_from (&ops[2], val, byte_mode, true);
2840 create_integer_operand (&ops[3], align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2841 if (nops == 6)
2843 create_integer_operand (&ops[4], expected_align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
2844 create_integer_operand (&ops[5], expected_size);
2846 if (maybe_expand_insn (code, nops, ops))
2847 return true;
2851 return false;
2855 /* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
2856 the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
2858 static void
2859 write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
2861 enum machine_mode cmode;
2862 enum machine_mode imode;
2863 unsigned ibitsize;
2865 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2867 emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
2868 return;
2871 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2872 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2873 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2875 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2876 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2877 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2878 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2879 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2880 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2882 emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2883 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
2884 val);
2885 return;
2888 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2889 will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
2890 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2891 correspond to TCmode. */
2892 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2893 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2894 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2895 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2896 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2897 || (REG_P (cplx)
2898 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2899 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2901 rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2902 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2903 if (part)
2905 emit_move_insn (part, val);
2906 return;
2908 else
2909 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2910 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2913 store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, 0, 0, imode, val);
2916 /* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
2917 real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
2919 static rtx
2920 read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
2922 enum machine_mode cmode, imode;
2923 unsigned ibitsize;
2925 if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
2926 return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
2928 cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
2929 imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
2930 ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
2932 /* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
2933 if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
2935 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
2936 if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
2938 tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
2939 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
2940 return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
2944 /* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
2945 because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
2946 by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
2947 adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
2948 invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
2949 if (MEM_P (cplx))
2950 return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
2951 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2953 /* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
2954 will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
2955 wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
2956 correspond to TCmode. */
2957 if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
2958 /* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
2959 the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
2960 This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
2961 where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
2962 || (REG_P (cplx)
2963 && REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
2964 && hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
2966 rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
2967 imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
2968 if (ret)
2969 return ret;
2970 else
2971 /* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
2972 gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
2975 return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
2976 true, false, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
2979 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
2980 NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
2981 represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
2982 we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
2984 static rtx
2985 emit_move_change_mode (enum machine_mode new_mode,
2986 enum machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
2988 rtx ret;
2990 if (push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
2992 ret = gen_rtx_MEM (new_mode, XEXP (x, 0));
2993 MEM_COPY_ATTRIBUTES (ret, x);
2995 else if (MEM_P (x))
2997 /* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
2998 size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
2999 if (reload_in_progress)
3001 /* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
3002 substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
3003 ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
3004 copy_replacements (x, ret);
3006 else
3007 ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
3009 else
3011 /* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
3012 that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
3013 simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
3014 probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
3015 /* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
3016 we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
3017 if (force)
3018 ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3019 else
3020 ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
3023 return ret;
3026 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
3027 an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
3028 emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
3030 static rtx
3031 emit_move_via_integer (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
3033 enum machine_mode imode;
3034 enum insn_code code;
3036 /* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
3037 imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
3038 if (imode == BLKmode)
3039 return NULL_RTX;
3041 /* The target must support moves in this mode. */
3042 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, imode);
3043 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3044 return NULL_RTX;
3046 x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
3047 if (x == NULL_RTX)
3048 return NULL_RTX;
3049 y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
3050 if (y == NULL_RTX)
3051 return NULL_RTX;
3052 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3055 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
3056 Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
3058 static rtx
3059 emit_move_resolve_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
3061 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
3062 HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
3063 rtx temp;
3065 adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3066 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3067 adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
3068 #endif
3069 if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
3070 adjust = -adjust;
3071 else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
3073 rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
3074 HOST_WIDE_INT val;
3076 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
3077 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (expr, 1)));
3078 val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
3079 if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
3080 val = -val;
3081 gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
3082 adjust = val;
3085 /* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
3086 stack_pointer_delta. */
3087 temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
3088 GEN_INT (adjust), stack_pointer_rtx,
3089 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3090 if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
3091 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
3093 switch (code)
3095 case PRE_INC:
3096 case PRE_DEC:
3097 case PRE_MODIFY:
3098 temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
3099 break;
3100 case POST_INC:
3101 case POST_DEC:
3102 case POST_MODIFY:
3103 temp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
3104 break;
3105 default:
3106 gcc_unreachable ();
3109 return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
3112 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
3113 X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
3114 Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3117 emit_move_complex_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3119 enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
3120 bool imag_first;
3122 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3123 unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
3125 /* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
3126 machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
3127 if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
3129 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3130 return emit_move_insn (x, y);
3132 #endif
3134 /* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
3135 regardless of machine's endianness. */
3136 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
3138 case PRE_DEC:
3139 case POST_DEC:
3140 imag_first = true;
3141 break;
3142 case PRE_INC:
3143 case POST_INC:
3144 imag_first = false;
3145 break;
3146 default:
3147 gcc_unreachable ();
3150 emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3151 read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
3152 return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
3153 read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
3156 /* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Perform the move from Y to X
3157 via two moves of the parts. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3160 emit_move_complex_parts (rtx x, rtx y)
3162 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3163 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3164 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
3165 if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
3166 && REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
3167 emit_clobber (x);
3169 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
3170 write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
3172 return get_last_insn ();
3175 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3176 MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3178 static rtx
3179 emit_move_complex (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3181 bool try_int;
3183 /* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
3184 of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
3185 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3186 return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
3188 /* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once. */
3190 /* Move floating point as parts. */
3191 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
3192 && optab_handler (mov_optab, GET_MODE_INNER (mode)) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3193 try_int = false;
3194 /* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
3195 else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
3196 try_int = false;
3197 /* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
3198 else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
3199 try_int = true;
3200 /* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
3201 are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
3202 We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
3203 usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
3204 else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
3205 && (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
3206 || get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
3207 try_int = true;
3208 else
3209 try_int = false;
3211 if (try_int)
3213 rtx ret;
3215 /* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
3216 existing block move logic. */
3217 if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
3219 emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
3220 BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
3221 return get_last_insn ();
3224 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3225 if (ret)
3226 return ret;
3229 return emit_move_complex_parts (x, y);
3232 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3233 MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
3235 static rtx
3236 emit_move_ccmode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3238 rtx ret;
3240 /* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
3241 if (mode != CCmode)
3243 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (mov_optab, CCmode);
3244 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3246 x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
3247 y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
3248 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3252 /* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
3253 ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3254 gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
3255 return ret;
3258 /* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
3259 undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3261 static bool
3262 undefined_operand_subword_p (const_rtx op, int i)
3264 enum machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
3265 int offset;
3266 if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
3267 return false;
3268 innermode = GET_MODE (op);
3269 innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
3270 offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
3271 /* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
3272 memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
3273 SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
3274 simplify_subreg. */
3275 if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
3276 && GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
3278 int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
3279 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
3280 offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
3281 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
3282 offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
3284 if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
3285 || offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
3286 return true;
3287 return false;
3290 /* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
3291 MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
3292 pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
3293 patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
3295 static rtx
3296 emit_move_multi_word (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
3298 rtx last_insn = 0;
3299 rtx seq, inner;
3300 bool need_clobber;
3301 int i;
3303 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
3305 /* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
3306 X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
3307 if (push_operand (x, mode))
3308 x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
3310 /* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
3311 is scheduled for replacement. */
3312 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
3313 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
3314 x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
3315 if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
3316 && (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
3317 y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
3319 start_sequence ();
3321 need_clobber = false;
3322 for (i = 0;
3323 i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
3324 i++)
3326 rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
3327 rtx ypart;
3329 /* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
3330 from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
3331 if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
3332 continue;
3334 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3336 /* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
3337 constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
3338 be able to get a part of Y. */
3339 if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
3341 y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
3342 ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
3344 else if (ypart == 0)
3345 ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
3347 gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
3349 need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
3351 last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
3354 seq = get_insns ();
3355 end_sequence ();
3357 /* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
3358 of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
3359 hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
3360 We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
3361 if (x != y
3362 && ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
3363 && need_clobber != 0)
3364 emit_clobber (x);
3366 emit_insn (seq);
3368 return last_insn;
3371 /* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
3372 Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
3373 are basically valid. */
3376 emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
3378 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3379 enum insn_code code;
3381 gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
3383 code = optab_handler (mov_optab, mode);
3384 if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3385 return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
3387 /* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
3388 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
3389 return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
3391 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT
3392 || ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
3394 rtx result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
3396 /* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
3397 if (result)
3398 return result;
3399 else
3400 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3403 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
3404 return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
3406 /* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
3407 only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
3408 constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
3409 fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
3410 if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
3412 rtx ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
3413 if (ret)
3414 return ret;
3417 return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
3420 /* Generate code to copy Y into X.
3421 Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
3422 Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
3423 This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
3425 Return the last instruction emitted. */
3428 emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
3430 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
3431 rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
3432 rtx last_insn, set;
3434 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
3435 && (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
3437 if (CONSTANT_P (y))
3439 if (optimize
3440 && SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
3441 && (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
3442 return last_insn;
3444 y_cst = y;
3446 if (!targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, y))
3448 y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
3450 /* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
3451 assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
3452 of the non-legitimate constant. */
3453 if (!y)
3454 y = y_cst;
3455 else
3456 y = use_anchored_address (y);
3460 /* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
3461 for the machine. */
3462 if (MEM_P (x)
3463 && (! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0),
3464 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (x))
3465 && ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x))))
3466 x = validize_mem (x);
3468 if (MEM_P (y)
3469 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0),
3470 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (y)))
3471 y = validize_mem (y);
3473 gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
3475 last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
3477 if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
3478 && (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
3479 && SET_DEST (set) == x
3480 && ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
3481 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, copy_rtx (y_cst));
3483 return last_insn;
3486 /* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
3487 perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
3488 move as an extension. */
3490 static rtx
3491 compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
3493 enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
3494 enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
3495 enum machine_mode srcmode;
3496 REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
3497 int oldcost, newcost;
3498 bool speed = optimize_insn_for_speed_p ();
3500 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
3502 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (dstmode, y))
3503 oldcost = set_src_cost (y, speed);
3504 else
3505 oldcost = set_src_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), speed);
3507 for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
3508 srcmode != orig_srcmode;
3509 srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
3511 enum insn_code ic;
3512 rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
3514 /* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
3515 ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
3516 if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
3517 continue;
3519 /* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
3520 if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
3521 continue;
3523 trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
3525 if (targetm.legitimate_constant_p (srcmode, trunc_y))
3527 /* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
3528 the extension. */
3529 if (!insn_operand_matches (ic, 1, trunc_y))
3530 continue;
3531 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3532 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3533 speed);
3534 if (oldcost < newcost)
3535 continue;
3537 else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
3539 trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
3540 /* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
3541 newcost = set_src_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y),
3542 speed);
3543 if (oldcost < newcost)
3544 continue;
3545 trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
3547 else
3548 continue;
3550 /* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
3551 into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
3552 and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
3553 trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
3554 emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
3555 last_insn = get_last_insn ();
3557 if (REG_P (x))
3558 set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
3560 return last_insn;
3563 return NULL_RTX;
3566 /* Pushing data onto the stack. */
3568 /* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
3569 and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
3570 The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
3572 EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
3573 BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
3574 otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
3577 push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
3579 rtx temp;
3581 size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
3582 if (CONSTANT_P (size))
3583 anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
3584 else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
3585 anti_adjust_stack (size);
3586 else
3588 temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
3589 if (extra != 0)
3590 temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
3591 temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
3592 anti_adjust_stack (temp);
3595 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3596 if (0)
3597 #else
3598 if (1)
3599 #endif
3601 temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
3602 if (extra != 0 && below)
3603 temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
3605 else
3607 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
3608 temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3609 -INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
3610 else if (extra != 0 && !below)
3611 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3612 negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
3613 else
3614 temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
3615 negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
3618 return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
3621 /* A utility routine that returns the base of an auto-inc memory, or NULL. */
3623 static rtx
3624 mem_autoinc_base (rtx mem)
3626 if (MEM_P (mem))
3628 rtx addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3629 if (GET_RTX_CLASS (GET_CODE (addr)) == RTX_AUTOINC)
3630 return XEXP (addr, 0);
3632 return NULL;
3635 /* A utility routine used here, in reload, and in try_split. The insns
3636 after PREV up to and including LAST are known to adjust the stack,
3637 with a final value of END_ARGS_SIZE. Iterate backward from LAST
3638 placing notes as appropriate. PREV may be NULL, indicating the
3639 entire insn sequence prior to LAST should be scanned.
3641 The set of allowed stack pointer modifications is small:
3642 (1) One or more auto-inc style memory references (aka pushes),
3643 (2) One or more addition/subtraction with the SP as destination,
3644 (3) A single move insn with the SP as destination,
3645 (4) A call_pop insn,
3646 (5) Noreturn call insns if !ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS.
3648 Insns in the sequence that do not modify the SP are ignored,
3649 except for noreturn calls.
3651 The return value is the amount of adjustment that can be trivially
3652 verified, via immediate operand or auto-inc. If the adjustment
3653 cannot be trivially extracted, the return value is INT_MIN. */
3655 HOST_WIDE_INT
3656 find_args_size_adjust (rtx insn)
3658 rtx dest, set, pat;
3659 int i;
3661 pat = PATTERN (insn);
3662 set = NULL;
3664 /* Look for a call_pop pattern. */
3665 if (CALL_P (insn))
3667 /* We have to allow non-call_pop patterns for the case
3668 of emit_single_push_insn of a TLS address. */
3669 if (GET_CODE (pat) != PARALLEL)
3670 return 0;
3672 /* All call_pop have a stack pointer adjust in the parallel.
3673 The call itself is always first, and the stack adjust is
3674 usually last, so search from the end. */
3675 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i > 0; --i)
3677 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3678 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3679 continue;
3680 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3681 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3682 break;
3684 /* We'd better have found the stack pointer adjust. */
3685 if (i == 0)
3686 return 0;
3687 /* Fall through to process the extracted SET and DEST
3688 as if it was a standalone insn. */
3690 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == SET)
3691 set = pat;
3692 else if ((set = single_set (insn)) != NULL)
3694 else if (GET_CODE (pat) == PARALLEL)
3696 /* ??? Some older ports use a parallel with a stack adjust
3697 and a store for a PUSH_ROUNDING pattern, rather than a
3698 PRE/POST_MODIFY rtx. Don't force them to update yet... */
3699 /* ??? See h8300 and m68k, pushqi1. */
3700 for (i = XVECLEN (pat, 0) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
3702 set = XVECEXP (pat, 0, i);
3703 if (GET_CODE (set) != SET)
3704 continue;
3705 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3706 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
3707 break;
3709 /* We do not expect an auto-inc of the sp in the parallel. */
3710 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (dest) != stack_pointer_rtx);
3711 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3712 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3714 if (i < 0)
3715 return 0;
3717 else
3718 return 0;
3720 dest = SET_DEST (set);
3722 /* Look for direct modifications of the stack pointer. */
3723 if (REG_P (dest) && REGNO (dest) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
3725 /* Look for a trivial adjustment, otherwise assume nothing. */
3726 /* Note that the SPU restore_stack_block pattern refers to
3727 the stack pointer in V4SImode. Consider that non-trivial. */
3728 if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dest))
3729 && GET_CODE (SET_SRC (set)) == PLUS
3730 && XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 0) == stack_pointer_rtx
3731 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1)))
3732 return INTVAL (XEXP (SET_SRC (set), 1));
3733 /* ??? Reload can generate no-op moves, which will be cleaned
3734 up later. Recognize it and continue searching. */
3735 else if (rtx_equal_p (dest, SET_SRC (set)))
3736 return 0;
3737 else
3738 return HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN;
3740 else
3742 rtx mem, addr;
3744 /* Otherwise only think about autoinc patterns. */
3745 if (mem_autoinc_base (dest) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3747 mem = dest;
3748 gcc_checking_assert (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set))
3749 != stack_pointer_rtx);
3751 else if (mem_autoinc_base (SET_SRC (set)) == stack_pointer_rtx)
3752 mem = SET_SRC (set);
3753 else
3754 return 0;
3756 addr = XEXP (mem, 0);
3757 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
3759 case PRE_INC:
3760 case POST_INC:
3761 return GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3762 case PRE_DEC:
3763 case POST_DEC:
3764 return -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (mem));
3765 case PRE_MODIFY:
3766 case POST_MODIFY:
3767 addr = XEXP (addr, 1);
3768 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (addr) == PLUS);
3769 gcc_assert (XEXP (addr, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
3770 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (addr, 1)));
3771 return INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1));
3772 default:
3773 gcc_unreachable ();
3779 fixup_args_size_notes (rtx prev, rtx last, int end_args_size)
3781 int args_size = end_args_size;
3782 bool saw_unknown = false;
3783 rtx insn;
3785 for (insn = last; insn != prev; insn = PREV_INSN (insn))
3787 HOST_WIDE_INT this_delta;
3789 if (!NONDEBUG_INSN_P (insn))
3790 continue;
3792 this_delta = find_args_size_adjust (insn);
3793 if (this_delta == 0)
3795 if (!CALL_P (insn)
3796 || ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3797 || find_reg_note (insn, REG_NORETURN, NULL_RTX) == NULL_RTX)
3798 continue;
3801 gcc_assert (!saw_unknown);
3802 if (this_delta == HOST_WIDE_INT_MIN)
3803 saw_unknown = true;
3805 add_reg_note (insn, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (args_size));
3806 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3807 this_delta = -this_delta;
3808 #endif
3809 args_size -= this_delta;
3812 return saw_unknown ? INT_MIN : args_size;
3815 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
3816 /* Emit single push insn. */
3818 static void
3819 emit_single_push_insn_1 (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3821 rtx dest_addr;
3822 unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3823 rtx dest;
3824 enum insn_code icode;
3826 stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
3827 /* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
3828 MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
3829 icode = optab_handler (push_optab, mode);
3830 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
3832 struct expand_operand ops[1];
3834 create_input_operand (&ops[0], x, mode);
3835 if (maybe_expand_insn (icode, 1, ops))
3836 return;
3838 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
3839 dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
3840 /* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
3841 then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
3842 because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
3843 access to type. */
3844 else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
3846 unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
3847 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
3849 emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
3850 expand_binop (Pmode,
3851 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3852 sub_optab,
3853 #else
3854 add_optab,
3855 #endif
3856 stack_pointer_rtx,
3857 GEN_INT (rounded_size),
3858 NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
3860 offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
3861 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3862 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3863 /* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
3864 previous value. */
3865 offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3866 #else
3867 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
3868 /* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
3869 previous value. */
3870 offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
3871 #endif
3872 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
3874 else
3876 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3877 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
3878 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3879 GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
3880 #else
3881 /* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
3882 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
3883 GEN_INT (rounded_size));
3884 #endif
3885 dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
3888 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
3890 if (type != 0)
3892 set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
3894 if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
3895 /* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
3896 outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
3897 from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
3898 of sibling calls. */
3899 set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
3901 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
3904 /* Emit and annotate a single push insn. */
3906 static void
3907 emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
3909 int delta, old_delta = stack_pointer_delta;
3910 rtx prev = get_last_insn ();
3911 rtx last;
3913 emit_single_push_insn_1 (mode, x, type);
3915 last = get_last_insn ();
3917 /* Notice the common case where we emitted exactly one insn. */
3918 if (PREV_INSN (last) == prev)
3920 add_reg_note (last, REG_ARGS_SIZE, GEN_INT (stack_pointer_delta));
3921 return;
3924 delta = fixup_args_size_notes (prev, last, stack_pointer_delta);
3925 gcc_assert (delta == INT_MIN || delta == old_delta);
3927 #endif
3929 /* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
3930 type TYPE.
3931 MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
3932 carry mode info).
3933 SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
3934 needed only if X is BLKmode.
3936 ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
3938 If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
3939 bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
3940 The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
3941 REG must be a hard register in this case.
3942 If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
3943 argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
3944 registers.
3946 EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
3947 This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
3949 On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
3950 the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
3951 to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
3952 argument block has not been preallocated.
3954 ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
3956 REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
3957 for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
3958 of bytes required. */
3960 void
3961 emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
3962 unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
3963 rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
3964 rtx alignment_pad)
3966 rtx xinner;
3967 enum direction stack_direction
3968 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3969 = downward;
3970 #else
3971 = upward;
3972 #endif
3974 /* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
3975 `upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
3976 Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
3977 enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
3979 /* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
3980 FIXME: why? */
3981 if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
3982 if (where_pad != none)
3983 where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
3985 xinner = x;
3987 if (mode == BLKmode
3988 || (STRICT_ALIGNMENT && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)))
3990 /* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
3992 rtx temp;
3993 int used;
3994 int offset;
3995 int skip;
3997 offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
3998 used = partial - offset;
4000 if (mode != BLKmode)
4002 /* A value is to be stored in an insufficiently aligned
4003 stack slot; copy via a suitably aligned slot if
4004 necessary. */
4005 size = GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
4006 if (!MEM_P (xinner))
4008 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
4009 emit_move_insn (temp, xinner);
4010 xinner = temp;
4014 gcc_assert (size);
4016 /* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
4017 because registers will take care of them. */
4019 if (partial != 0)
4020 xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
4022 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4023 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4024 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4025 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4026 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
4028 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4029 /* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
4030 and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
4031 on the stack for alignment purposes. */
4032 if (args_addr == 0
4033 && PUSH_ARGS
4034 && CONST_INT_P (size)
4035 && skip == 0
4036 && MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
4037 && (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
4038 /* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
4039 forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
4040 and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
4041 && ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
4042 || align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
4043 || (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
4044 == (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
4045 && (HOST_WIDE_INT) PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
4047 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4048 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4049 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4050 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4051 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4052 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4054 move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
4056 else
4057 #endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
4059 rtx target;
4061 /* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
4062 to the address of that space. */
4064 /* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
4065 if (partial != 0)
4067 if (CONST_INT_P (size))
4068 size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
4069 else
4070 size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
4071 GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
4072 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
4075 /* Get the address of the stack space.
4076 In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
4077 A single stack adjust will do. */
4078 if (! args_addr)
4080 temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
4081 extra = 0;
4083 else if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4084 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4085 plus_constant (args_addr,
4086 skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4087 else
4088 temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
4089 plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
4090 args_addr,
4091 args_so_far),
4092 skip));
4094 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
4096 /* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
4097 copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
4098 to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
4100 if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
4101 || reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
4102 temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
4105 target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
4107 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4108 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4109 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4110 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4111 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4112 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4113 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4114 set_mem_align (target, align);
4116 emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
4119 else if (partial > 0)
4121 /* Scalar partly in registers. */
4123 int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4124 int i;
4125 int not_stack;
4126 /* # bytes of start of argument
4127 that we must make space for but need not store. */
4128 int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4129 int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
4130 int skip;
4132 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4133 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4134 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4135 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4136 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4137 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4139 /* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
4140 the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
4141 and leave the space uninitialized. */
4142 if (args_addr == 0)
4143 offset = 0;
4145 /* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
4146 allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
4147 not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
4148 offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
4150 /* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
4151 skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
4152 Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
4153 by setting SKIP to 0. */
4154 skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
4156 if (CONSTANT_P (x) && !targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode, x))
4157 x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
4159 /* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
4160 SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
4161 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4162 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
4163 x = copy_to_reg (x);
4165 /* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
4166 /* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
4167 has a size a multiple of a word. */
4168 #ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
4169 for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
4170 #else
4171 for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
4172 #endif
4173 if (i >= not_stack + offset)
4174 emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
4175 word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
4176 0, args_addr,
4177 GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
4178 * UNITS_PER_WORD)),
4179 reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
4181 else
4183 rtx addr;
4184 rtx dest;
4186 /* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
4187 or if padding below and stack grows up.
4188 But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
4189 if (extra && args_addr == 0
4190 && where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
4191 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4193 #ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
4194 if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
4195 emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
4196 else
4197 #endif
4199 if (CONST_INT_P (args_so_far))
4200 addr
4201 = memory_address (mode,
4202 plus_constant (args_addr,
4203 INTVAL (args_so_far)));
4204 else
4205 addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
4206 args_so_far));
4207 dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
4209 /* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
4210 may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
4211 allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
4212 to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
4213 to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
4214 /* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
4215 PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
4216 set_mem_align (dest, align);
4218 emit_move_insn (dest, x);
4222 /* If part should go in registers, copy that part
4223 into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
4224 since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
4225 if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
4227 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4228 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4229 if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
4230 emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
4231 else
4233 gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
4234 move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
4238 if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
4239 anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
4241 if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
4242 anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
4245 /* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
4246 operations. */
4248 static rtx
4249 get_subtarget (rtx x)
4251 return (optimize
4252 || x == 0
4253 /* Only registers can be subtargets. */
4254 || !REG_P (x)
4255 /* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
4256 || REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
4257 ? 0 : x);
4260 /* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
4261 FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
4262 and there's nothing else to do. */
4264 static bool
4265 optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
4266 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
4267 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
4268 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
4269 enum machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
4270 tree to, tree src)
4272 enum machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
4273 unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4274 tree op0, op1;
4275 rtx value, result;
4276 optab binop;
4277 gimple srcstmt;
4278 enum tree_code code;
4280 if (mode1 != VOIDmode
4281 || bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
4282 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
4283 || TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
4284 || TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4285 return false;
4287 STRIP_NOPS (src);
4288 if (TREE_CODE (src) != SSA_NAME)
4289 return false;
4290 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
4291 return false;
4293 srcstmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (src);
4294 if (!srcstmt
4295 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt)) != tcc_binary)
4296 return false;
4298 code = gimple_assign_rhs_code (srcstmt);
4300 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt);
4302 /* If OP0 is an SSA_NAME, then we want to walk the use-def chain
4303 to find its initialization. Hopefully the initialization will
4304 be from a bitfield load. */
4305 if (TREE_CODE (op0) == SSA_NAME)
4307 gimple op0stmt = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (op0);
4309 /* We want to eventually have OP0 be the same as TO, which
4310 should be a bitfield. */
4311 if (!op0stmt
4312 || !is_gimple_assign (op0stmt)
4313 || gimple_assign_rhs_code (op0stmt) != TREE_CODE (to))
4314 return false;
4315 op0 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (op0stmt);
4318 op1 = gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt);
4320 if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
4321 return false;
4323 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4325 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
4327 if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
4328 str_mode = word_mode;
4329 str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
4330 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4331 MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
4332 if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
4333 return false;
4334 str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
4336 offset1 = bitpos;
4337 bitpos %= str_bitsize;
4338 offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
4339 str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
4341 else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
4342 return false;
4344 /* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
4345 will likely generate better code. */
4346 if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
4347 return false;
4349 /* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
4350 if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
4351 return false;
4353 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
4354 bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
4356 switch (code)
4358 case PLUS_EXPR:
4359 case MINUS_EXPR:
4360 /* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
4361 where we don't need to do any masking and also
4362 1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
4363 We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
4364 too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
4365 can be added later. */
4366 if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
4367 && (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
4368 break;
4370 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4371 value = convert_modes (str_mode,
4372 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4373 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4375 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4376 we can alias adjacent data. */
4377 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4379 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4380 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4381 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4384 binop = code == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
4385 if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
4387 value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
4388 binop = xor_optab;
4390 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value,
4391 bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4392 result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
4393 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4394 if (result != str_rtx)
4395 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4396 return true;
4398 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
4399 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
4400 if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
4401 break;
4402 value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (str_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4403 value = convert_modes (GET_MODE (str_rtx),
4404 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
4405 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
4407 /* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
4408 we can alias adjacent data. */
4409 if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
4411 str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
4412 set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
4413 set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
4416 binop = code == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
4417 if (bitpos + bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
4419 rtx mask = GEN_INT (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize)
4420 - 1);
4421 value = expand_and (GET_MODE (str_rtx), value, mask,
4422 NULL_RTX);
4424 value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (str_rtx), value,
4425 bitpos, NULL_RTX, 1);
4426 result = expand_binop (GET_MODE (str_rtx), binop, str_rtx,
4427 value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
4428 if (result != str_rtx)
4429 emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
4430 return true;
4432 default:
4433 break;
4436 return false;
4439 /* In the C++ memory model, consecutive bit fields in a structure are
4440 considered one memory location.
4442 Given a COMPONENT_REF, this function returns the bit range of
4443 consecutive bits in which this COMPONENT_REF belongs in. The
4444 values are returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND. If either the C++
4445 memory model is not activated, or this memory access is not thread
4446 visible, 0 is returned in *BITSTART and *BITEND.
4448 EXP is the COMPONENT_REF.
4449 INNERDECL is the actual object being referenced.
4450 BITPOS is the position in bits where the bit starts within the structure.
4451 BITSIZE is size in bits of the field being referenced in EXP.
4453 For example, while storing into FOO.A here...
4455 struct {
4456 BIT 0:
4457 unsigned int a : 4;
4458 unsigned int b : 1;
4459 BIT 8:
4460 unsigned char c;
4461 unsigned int d : 6;
4462 } foo;
4464 ...we are not allowed to store past <b>, so for the layout above, a
4465 range of 0..7 (because no one cares if we store into the
4466 padding). */
4468 static void
4469 get_bit_range (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitstart,
4470 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT *bitend,
4471 tree exp, tree innerdecl,
4472 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
4474 tree field, record_type, fld;
4475 bool found_field = false;
4476 bool prev_field_is_bitfield;
4478 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF);
4480 /* If other threads can't see this value, no need to restrict stores. */
4481 if (ALLOW_STORE_DATA_RACES
4482 || ((TREE_CODE (innerdecl) == MEM_REF
4483 || TREE_CODE (innerdecl) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4484 && !ptr_deref_may_alias_global_p (TREE_OPERAND (innerdecl, 0)))
4485 || (DECL_P (innerdecl)
4486 && ((TREE_CODE (innerdecl) == VAR_DECL
4487 && DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (innerdecl))
4488 || !TREE_STATIC (innerdecl))))
4490 *bitstart = *bitend = 0;
4491 return;
4494 /* Bit field we're storing into. */
4495 field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
4496 record_type = DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (field);
4498 /* Count the contiguous bitfields for the memory location that
4499 contains FIELD. */
4500 *bitstart = 0;
4501 prev_field_is_bitfield = true;
4502 for (fld = TYPE_FIELDS (record_type); fld; fld = DECL_CHAIN (fld))
4504 tree t, offset;
4505 enum machine_mode mode;
4506 int unsignedp, volatilep;
4508 if (TREE_CODE (fld) != FIELD_DECL)
4509 continue;
4511 t = build3 (COMPONENT_REF, TREE_TYPE (exp),
4512 unshare_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
4513 fld, NULL_TREE);
4514 get_inner_reference (t, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
4515 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4517 if (field == fld)
4518 found_field = true;
4520 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (fld) && bitsize > 0)
4522 if (prev_field_is_bitfield == false)
4524 *bitstart = bitpos;
4525 prev_field_is_bitfield = true;
4528 else
4530 prev_field_is_bitfield = false;
4531 if (found_field)
4532 break;
4535 gcc_assert (found_field);
4537 if (fld)
4539 /* We found the end of the bit field sequence. Include the
4540 padding up to the next field and be done. */
4541 *bitend = bitpos - 1;
4543 else
4545 /* If this is the last element in the structure, include the padding
4546 at the end of structure. */
4547 *bitend = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (record_type)) - 1;
4551 /* Returns true if the MEM_REF REF refers to an object that does not
4552 reside in memory and has non-BLKmode. */
4554 static bool
4555 mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (tree ref)
4557 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (ref, 0);
4558 if (TREE_CODE (base) != ADDR_EXPR)
4559 return false;
4560 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
4561 return (DECL_P (base)
4562 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (base)
4563 && DECL_MODE (base) != BLKmode
4564 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (base)
4565 && !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (base)));
4568 /* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. If NONTEMPORAL
4569 is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
4571 void
4572 expand_assignment (tree to, tree from, bool nontemporal)
4574 rtx to_rtx = 0;
4575 rtx result;
4576 enum machine_mode mode;
4577 unsigned int align;
4578 enum insn_code icode;
4580 /* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
4581 if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
4583 expand_normal (from);
4584 return;
4587 /* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
4588 if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
4589 return;
4591 /* Handle misaligned stores. */
4592 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (to));
4593 if ((TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4594 || TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4595 && mode != BLKmode
4596 && !mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to)
4597 && ((align = get_object_or_type_alignment (to))
4598 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4599 && (((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4600 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4601 || SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, align)))
4603 addr_space_t as
4604 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 0))));
4605 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4606 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4607 rtx reg, op0, mem;
4609 reg = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4610 reg = force_not_mem (reg);
4612 if (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF)
4614 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (to, 0);
4615 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
4616 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4617 op0 = convert_memory_address_addr_space (address_mode, op0, as);
4618 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4620 rtx off
4621 = immed_double_int_const (mem_ref_offset (to), address_mode);
4622 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
4624 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
4625 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
4626 set_mem_attributes (mem, to, 0);
4627 set_mem_addr_space (mem, as);
4629 else if (TREE_CODE (to) == TARGET_MEM_REF)
4631 struct mem_address addr;
4632 get_address_description (to, &addr);
4633 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, as, true);
4634 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
4635 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
4636 set_mem_attributes (mem, to, 0);
4637 set_mem_addr_space (mem, as);
4639 else
4640 gcc_unreachable ();
4641 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
4642 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = 1;
4644 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
4646 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4647 create_input_operand (&ops[1], reg, mode);
4648 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4649 would silently be omitted. */
4650 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4652 else
4653 store_bit_field (mem, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
4654 0, 0, 0, mode, reg);
4655 return;
4658 /* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
4659 if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
4660 Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
4661 an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
4662 problem. Same for (partially) storing into a non-memory object. */
4663 if (handled_component_p (to)
4664 || (TREE_CODE (to) == MEM_REF
4665 && mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (to))
4666 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4668 enum machine_mode mode1;
4669 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
4670 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start = 0;
4671 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end = 0;
4672 tree offset;
4673 int unsignedp;
4674 int volatilep = 0;
4675 tree tem;
4676 bool misalignp;
4677 rtx mem = NULL_RTX;
4679 push_temp_slots ();
4680 tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
4681 &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
4683 if (TREE_CODE (to) == COMPONENT_REF
4684 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (to, 1)))
4685 get_bit_range (&bitregion_start, &bitregion_end,
4686 to, tem, bitpos, bitsize);
4688 /* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
4689 make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
4690 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
4691 if (TREE_CODE (tem) == MEM_REF
4692 && mode != BLKmode
4693 && ((align = get_object_or_type_alignment (tem))
4694 < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
4695 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
4696 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
4698 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4699 rtx op0;
4700 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4701 addr_space_t as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE
4702 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (tem, 0))));
4703 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (tem, 0);
4705 misalignp = true;
4706 to_rtx = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
4708 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
4709 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
4710 op0 = convert_memory_address_addr_space (address_mode, op0, as);
4711 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (tem, 1)))
4713 rtx off = immed_double_int_const (mem_ref_offset (tem),
4714 address_mode);
4715 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
4717 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
4718 mem = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
4719 set_mem_attributes (mem, tem, 0);
4720 set_mem_addr_space (mem, as);
4721 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tem))
4722 MEM_VOLATILE_P (mem) = 1;
4724 /* If the misaligned store doesn't overwrite all bits, perform
4725 rmw cycle on MEM. */
4726 if (bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
4728 create_input_operand (&ops[0], to_rtx, mode);
4729 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], mem);
4730 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4731 would silently be omitted. */
4732 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4734 mem = copy_rtx (mem);
4737 else
4739 misalignp = false;
4740 to_rtx = expand_normal (tem);
4743 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
4744 field's mode, not the computed mode.
4745 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
4746 use BLKmode for it instead. */
4747 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4749 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
4750 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, 0);
4751 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == VOIDmode)
4752 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, BLKmode, 0);
4755 if (offset != 0)
4757 enum machine_mode address_mode;
4758 rtx offset_rtx;
4760 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
4762 /* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
4763 user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
4764 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
4765 expand_builtin_trap ();
4766 to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
4769 offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
4770 address_mode
4771 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to_rtx));
4772 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
4773 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
4775 /* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
4776 to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
4777 if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
4778 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
4779 && GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
4780 && bitsize > 0
4781 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
4782 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
4783 && MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
4785 to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
4786 bitpos = 0;
4789 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
4790 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
4791 offset));
4794 /* No action is needed if the target is not a memory and the field
4795 lies completely outside that target. This can occur if the source
4796 code contains an out-of-bounds access to a small array. */
4797 if (!MEM_P (to_rtx)
4798 && GET_MODE (to_rtx) != BLKmode
4799 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bitpos
4800 >= GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (to_rtx)))
4802 expand_normal (from);
4803 result = NULL;
4805 /* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
4806 else if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
4808 unsigned short mode_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx));
4809 if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)))
4810 && bitpos == 0
4811 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4812 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false, nontemporal);
4813 else if (bitsize == mode_bitsize / 2
4814 && (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == mode_bitsize / 2))
4815 result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false,
4816 nontemporal);
4817 else if (bitpos + bitsize <= mode_bitsize / 2)
4818 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), bitsize, bitpos,
4819 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4820 mode1, from, TREE_TYPE (tem),
4821 get_alias_set (to), nontemporal);
4822 else if (bitpos >= mode_bitsize / 2)
4823 result = store_field (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), bitsize,
4824 bitpos - mode_bitsize / 2,
4825 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4826 mode1, from,
4827 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4828 nontemporal);
4829 else if (bitpos == 0 && bitsize == mode_bitsize)
4831 rtx from_rtx;
4832 result = expand_normal (from);
4833 from_rtx = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), result,
4834 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)), 0);
4835 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0),
4836 read_complex_part (from_rtx, false));
4837 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1),
4838 read_complex_part (from_rtx, true));
4840 else
4842 rtx temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (to_rtx),
4843 GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (to_rtx)),
4845 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), false);
4846 write_complex_part (temp, XEXP (to_rtx, 1), true);
4847 result = store_field (temp, bitsize, bitpos,
4848 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4849 mode1, from,
4850 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4851 nontemporal);
4852 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 0), read_complex_part (temp, false));
4853 emit_move_insn (XEXP (to_rtx, 1), read_complex_part (temp, true));
4856 else
4858 if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
4860 /* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
4861 DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
4862 to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
4864 set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
4866 /* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only
4867 done for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
4868 if (volatilep)
4869 MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4870 if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (to))
4871 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
4874 if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos,
4875 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4876 mode1,
4877 to_rtx, to, from))
4878 result = NULL;
4879 else
4880 result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos,
4881 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
4882 mode1, from,
4883 TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to),
4884 nontemporal);
4887 if (misalignp)
4889 struct expand_operand ops[2];
4891 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], mem);
4892 create_input_operand (&ops[1], to_rtx, mode);
4893 /* The movmisalign<mode> pattern cannot fail, else the assignment
4894 would silently be omitted. */
4895 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
4898 if (result)
4899 preserve_temp_slots (result);
4900 free_temp_slots ();
4901 pop_temp_slots ();
4902 return;
4905 /* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
4906 call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
4907 This is needed for correct code for cases such as
4908 val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
4909 requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
4911 Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
4912 since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
4913 needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
4914 computation is done before the call. The same is true for SSA names. */
4915 if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
4916 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (from))
4917 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
4918 && ! (((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL
4919 || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL
4920 || TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL)
4921 && REG_P (DECL_RTL (to)))
4922 || TREE_CODE (to) == SSA_NAME))
4924 rtx value;
4926 push_temp_slots ();
4927 value = expand_normal (from);
4928 if (to_rtx == 0)
4929 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4931 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
4932 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
4933 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4934 emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
4935 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4936 else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
4937 emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
4938 else
4940 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
4941 value = convert_memory_address_addr_space
4942 (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value,
4943 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (to))));
4945 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
4947 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4948 free_temp_slots ();
4949 pop_temp_slots ();
4950 return;
4953 /* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx. */
4954 to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
4956 /* Don't move directly into a return register. */
4957 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4958 && (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
4960 rtx temp;
4962 push_temp_slots ();
4963 if (REG_P (to_rtx) && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == BLKmode)
4964 temp = copy_blkmode_to_reg (GET_MODE (to_rtx), from);
4965 else
4966 temp = expand_expr (from, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (to_rtx), EXPAND_NORMAL);
4968 if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
4969 emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
4970 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
4971 else if (temp)
4972 emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
4974 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
4975 free_temp_slots ();
4976 pop_temp_slots ();
4977 return;
4980 /* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
4981 the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
4982 a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
4983 if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
4984 && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
4985 && ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P
4986 (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (from, 0)))))
4987 && refs_may_alias_p (to, from)
4988 && cfun->returns_struct
4989 && !cfun->returns_pcc_struct)
4991 rtx from_rtx, size;
4993 push_temp_slots ();
4994 size = expr_size (from);
4995 from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
4997 emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
4998 VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
4999 XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
5000 convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
5001 size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
5002 TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
5004 preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
5005 free_temp_slots ();
5006 pop_temp_slots ();
5007 return;
5010 /* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
5012 push_temp_slots ();
5013 result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
5014 preserve_temp_slots (result);
5015 free_temp_slots ();
5016 pop_temp_slots ();
5017 return;
5020 /* Emits nontemporal store insn that moves FROM to TO. Returns true if this
5021 succeeded, false otherwise. */
5023 bool
5024 emit_storent_insn (rtx to, rtx from)
5026 struct expand_operand ops[2];
5027 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (to);
5028 enum insn_code code = optab_handler (storent_optab, mode);
5030 if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
5031 return false;
5033 create_fixed_operand (&ops[0], to);
5034 create_input_operand (&ops[1], from, mode);
5035 return maybe_expand_insn (code, 2, ops);
5038 /* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
5039 and storing the value into TARGET.
5041 If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
5042 It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
5043 because C has no operators that could combine two different
5044 assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
5045 with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
5046 be more thorough?
5048 If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
5049 stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially.
5051 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try using a nontemporal store instruction. */
5054 store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p, bool nontemporal)
5056 rtx temp;
5057 rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
5058 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
5060 if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5062 /* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
5063 branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
5064 store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
5065 gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
5066 expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
5067 return NULL_RTX;
5069 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
5071 /* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
5072 part. */
5073 expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
5074 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5075 return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5076 nontemporal);
5078 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5080 /* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
5081 test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
5082 side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
5083 For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
5085 rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
5087 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
5088 NO_DEFER_POP;
5089 jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1, -1);
5090 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p,
5091 nontemporal);
5092 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
5093 emit_barrier ();
5094 emit_label (lab1);
5095 store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p,
5096 nontemporal);
5097 emit_label (lab2);
5098 OK_DEFER_POP;
5100 return NULL_RTX;
5102 else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
5103 /* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
5104 than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
5105 and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
5106 expression. */
5108 rtx inner_target = 0;
5110 /* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
5111 in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
5112 change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
5113 do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
5114 since then the conversion might involve more than just
5115 converting modes. */
5116 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5117 && TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
5118 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
5119 == TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5121 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
5122 != SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
5124 /* Some types, e.g. Fortran's logical*4, won't have a signed
5125 version, so use the mode instead. */
5126 tree ntype
5127 = (signed_or_unsigned_type_for
5128 (SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5129 if (ntype == NULL)
5130 ntype = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5131 (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5132 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5134 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, ntype, exp);
5137 exp = fold_convert_loc (loc, lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5138 (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5139 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
5140 exp);
5142 inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
5145 temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
5146 call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
5148 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
5149 sure that we properly convert it. */
5150 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
5152 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5153 temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5154 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
5155 GET_MODE (target), temp,
5156 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5159 convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
5160 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
5162 return NULL_RTX;
5164 else if ((TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5165 || (TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
5166 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
5167 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
5168 == STRING_CST
5169 && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
5170 && !nontemporal && !call_param_p
5171 && MEM_P (target))
5173 /* Optimize initialization of an array with a STRING_CST. */
5174 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_len, str_copy_len;
5175 rtx dest_mem;
5176 tree str = TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST
5177 ? exp : TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
5179 exp_len = int_expr_size (exp);
5180 if (exp_len <= 0)
5181 goto normal_expr;
5183 if (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) <= 0)
5184 goto normal_expr;
5186 str_copy_len = strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (str));
5187 if (str_copy_len < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1)
5188 goto normal_expr;
5190 str_copy_len = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str);
5191 if ((STORE_MAX_PIECES & (STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1)) == 0
5192 && TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)[TREE_STRING_LENGTH (str) - 1] == '\0')
5194 str_copy_len += STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1;
5195 str_copy_len &= ~(STORE_MAX_PIECES - 1);
5197 str_copy_len = MIN (str_copy_len, exp_len);
5198 if (!can_store_by_pieces (str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5199 CONST_CAST (char *, TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5200 MEM_ALIGN (target), false))
5201 goto normal_expr;
5203 dest_mem = target;
5205 dest_mem = store_by_pieces (dest_mem,
5206 str_copy_len, builtin_strncpy_read_str,
5207 CONST_CAST (char *,
5208 TREE_STRING_POINTER (str)),
5209 MEM_ALIGN (target), false,
5210 exp_len > str_copy_len ? 1 : 0);
5211 if (exp_len > str_copy_len)
5212 clear_storage (adjust_address (dest_mem, BLKmode, 0),
5213 GEN_INT (exp_len - str_copy_len),
5214 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5215 return NULL_RTX;
5217 else
5219 rtx tmp_target;
5221 normal_expr:
5222 /* If we want to use a nontemporal store, force the value to
5223 register first. */
5224 tmp_target = nontemporal ? NULL_RTX : target;
5225 temp = expand_expr_real (exp, tmp_target, GET_MODE (target),
5226 (call_param_p
5227 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
5228 &alt_rtl);
5231 /* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
5232 the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
5233 example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
5234 value. */
5235 if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
5236 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5237 && GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
5238 temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
5239 temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5241 /* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
5242 Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
5243 pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
5244 Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
5245 effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
5247 If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
5248 one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
5249 two cases:
5250 - expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
5251 another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
5252 to == .
5253 - expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
5254 happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
5255 by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
5256 We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
5257 of volatile memory references. */
5259 if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
5260 || (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
5261 || side_effects_p (target))))
5262 && TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
5263 /* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
5264 but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
5265 from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
5266 && !(alt_rtl
5267 && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target)
5268 && !side_effects_p (alt_rtl)
5269 && !side_effects_p (target))
5270 /* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
5271 expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
5272 expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
5273 supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
5274 && expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
5276 if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
5277 && GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
5279 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
5280 if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5281 && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5282 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5283 (call_param_p
5284 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
5285 : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5286 else if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
5287 store_bit_field (target, INTVAL (expr_size (exp)) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
5288 0, 0, 0, GET_MODE (temp), temp);
5289 else
5290 convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
5293 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
5295 /* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
5296 constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
5297 actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
5298 type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
5299 rtx size = expr_size (exp);
5301 if (CONST_INT_P (size)
5302 && INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
5303 emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
5304 (call_param_p
5305 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5306 else
5308 enum machine_mode pointer_mode
5309 = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5310 enum machine_mode address_mode
5311 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (target));
5313 /* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
5314 tree copy_size
5315 = size_binop_loc (loc, MIN_EXPR,
5316 make_tree (sizetype, size),
5317 size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
5318 rtx copy_size_rtx
5319 = expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
5320 (call_param_p
5321 ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
5322 rtx label = 0;
5324 /* Copy that much. */
5325 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (pointer_mode, copy_size_rtx,
5326 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5327 emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
5328 (call_param_p
5329 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5331 /* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
5332 Do all calculations in pointer_mode. */
5333 if (CONST_INT_P (copy_size_rtx))
5335 size = plus_constant (size, -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5336 target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
5337 INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
5339 else
5341 size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
5342 copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
5343 OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
5345 if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != address_mode)
5346 copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode,
5347 copy_size_rtx,
5348 TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
5350 target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
5351 highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
5352 label = gen_label_rtx ();
5353 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
5354 GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
5357 if (size != const0_rtx)
5358 clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5360 if (label)
5361 emit_label (label);
5364 /* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
5365 The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
5366 else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
5367 emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
5368 int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
5369 else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
5370 emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
5371 (call_param_p
5372 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
5373 else if (nontemporal
5374 && emit_storent_insn (target, temp))
5375 /* If we managed to emit a nontemporal store, there is nothing else to
5376 do. */
5378 else
5380 temp = force_operand (temp, target);
5381 if (temp != target)
5382 emit_move_insn (target, temp);
5386 return NULL_RTX;
5389 /* Return true if field F of structure TYPE is a flexible array. */
5391 static bool
5392 flexible_array_member_p (const_tree f, const_tree type)
5394 const_tree tf;
5396 tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
5397 return (DECL_CHAIN (f) == NULL
5398 && TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
5399 && TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
5400 && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5401 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
5402 && !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
5403 && int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0);
5406 /* If FOR_CTOR_P, return the number of top-level elements that a constructor
5407 must have in order for it to completely initialize a value of type TYPE.
5408 Return -1 if the number isn't known.
5410 If !FOR_CTOR_P, return an estimate of the number of scalars in TYPE. */
5412 static HOST_WIDE_INT
5413 count_type_elements (const_tree type, bool for_ctor_p)
5415 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5417 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5419 tree nelts;
5421 nelts = array_type_nelts (type);
5422 if (nelts && host_integerp (nelts, 1))
5424 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5426 n = tree_low_cst (nelts, 1) + 1;
5427 if (n == 0 || for_ctor_p)
5428 return n;
5429 else
5430 return n * count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
5432 return for_ctor_p ? -1 : 1;
5435 case RECORD_TYPE:
5437 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n;
5438 tree f;
5440 n = 0;
5441 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5442 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5444 if (!for_ctor_p)
5445 n += count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5446 else if (!flexible_array_member_p (f, type))
5447 /* Don't count flexible arrays, which are not supposed
5448 to be initialized. */
5449 n += 1;
5452 return n;
5455 case UNION_TYPE:
5456 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5458 tree f;
5459 HOST_WIDE_INT n, m;
5461 gcc_assert (!for_ctor_p);
5462 /* Estimate the number of scalars in each field and pick the
5463 maximum. Other estimates would do instead; the idea is simply
5464 to make sure that the estimate is not sensitive to the ordering
5465 of the fields. */
5466 n = 1;
5467 for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = DECL_CHAIN (f))
5468 if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
5470 m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
5471 /* If the field doesn't span the whole union, add an extra
5472 scalar for the rest. */
5473 if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (f)),
5474 TYPE_SIZE (type)) != 1)
5475 m++;
5476 if (n < m)
5477 n = m;
5479 return n;
5482 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
5483 return 2;
5485 case VECTOR_TYPE:
5486 return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
5488 case INTEGER_TYPE:
5489 case REAL_TYPE:
5490 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
5491 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
5492 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
5493 case POINTER_TYPE:
5494 case OFFSET_TYPE:
5495 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
5496 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
5497 return 1;
5499 case ERROR_MARK:
5500 return 0;
5502 case VOID_TYPE:
5503 case METHOD_TYPE:
5504 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
5505 case LANG_TYPE:
5506 default:
5507 gcc_unreachable ();
5511 /* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
5513 static bool
5514 categorize_ctor_elements_1 (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5515 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5517 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5518 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts, num_fields;
5519 tree value, purpose, elt_type;
5521 /* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
5522 initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
5523 elements, true until proven otherwise. */
5524 bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
5525 bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
5527 nz_elts = 0;
5528 init_elts = 0;
5529 num_fields = 0;
5530 elt_type = NULL_TREE;
5532 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
5534 HOST_WIDE_INT mult = 1;
5536 if (TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
5538 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
5539 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
5541 if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5542 mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5543 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5545 num_fields += mult;
5546 elt_type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5548 switch (TREE_CODE (value))
5550 case CONSTRUCTOR:
5552 HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
5554 bool const_elt_p = categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic,
5555 p_complete);
5557 nz_elts += mult * nz;
5558 init_elts += mult * ic;
5560 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5561 const_p = const_elt_p;
5563 break;
5565 case INTEGER_CST:
5566 case REAL_CST:
5567 case FIXED_CST:
5568 if (!initializer_zerop (value))
5569 nz_elts += mult;
5570 init_elts += mult;
5571 break;
5573 case STRING_CST:
5574 nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5575 init_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
5576 break;
5578 case COMPLEX_CST:
5579 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
5580 nz_elts += mult;
5581 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
5582 nz_elts += mult;
5583 init_elts += mult;
5584 break;
5586 case VECTOR_CST:
5588 tree v;
5589 for (v = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (value); v; v = TREE_CHAIN (v))
5591 if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_VALUE (v)))
5592 nz_elts += mult;
5593 init_elts += mult;
5596 break;
5598 default:
5600 HOST_WIDE_INT tc = count_type_elements (elt_type, false);
5601 nz_elts += mult * tc;
5602 init_elts += mult * tc;
5604 if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
5605 const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, elt_type)
5606 != NULL_TREE;
5608 break;
5612 if (*p_complete && !complete_ctor_at_level_p (TREE_TYPE (ctor),
5613 num_fields, elt_type))
5614 *p_complete = false;
5616 *p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
5617 *p_init_elts += init_elts;
5619 return const_p;
5622 /* Examine CTOR to discover:
5623 * how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
5624 and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
5625 * how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
5626 and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
5627 * whether the constructor is complete -- in the sense that every
5628 meaningful byte is explicitly given a value --
5629 and place it in *P_COMPLETE.
5631 Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
5632 as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
5634 bool
5635 categorize_ctor_elements (const_tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
5636 HOST_WIDE_INT *p_init_elts, bool *p_complete)
5638 *p_nz_elts = 0;
5639 *p_init_elts = 0;
5640 *p_complete = true;
5642 return categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_init_elts, p_complete);
5645 /* TYPE is initialized by a constructor with NUM_ELTS elements, the last
5646 of which had type LAST_TYPE. Each element was itself a complete
5647 initializer, in the sense that every meaningful byte was explicitly
5648 given a value. Return true if the same is true for the constructor
5649 as a whole. */
5651 bool
5652 complete_ctor_at_level_p (const_tree type, HOST_WIDE_INT num_elts,
5653 const_tree last_type)
5655 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5656 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5658 if (num_elts == 0)
5659 return false;
5661 gcc_assert (num_elts == 1 && last_type);
5663 /* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
5664 largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
5665 initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
5666 Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
5667 return simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (type), TYPE_SIZE (last_type)) == 1;
5670 return count_type_elements (type, true) == num_elts;
5673 /* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
5675 static int
5676 mostly_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5678 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5680 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5681 bool complete_p;
5683 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5684 return !complete_p || nz_elts < init_elts / 4;
5687 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5690 /* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
5692 static int
5693 all_zeros_p (const_tree exp)
5695 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
5697 HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, init_elts;
5698 bool complete_p;
5700 categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &init_elts, &complete_p);
5701 return nz_elts == 0;
5704 return initializer_zerop (exp);
5707 /* Helper function for store_constructor.
5708 TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
5709 TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
5710 CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
5711 ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
5713 This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
5714 necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
5715 the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
5716 clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
5718 static void
5719 store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
5720 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
5721 tree exp, tree type, int cleared,
5722 alias_set_type alias_set)
5724 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
5725 /* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
5726 bit position are on a byte boundary. */
5727 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
5728 && (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
5729 /* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
5730 let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
5731 generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
5732 && (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
5734 if (MEM_P (target))
5735 target
5736 = adjust_address (target,
5737 GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
5738 || 0 != (bitpos
5739 % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
5740 ? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5743 /* Update the alias set, if required. */
5744 if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
5745 && MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
5747 target = copy_rtx (target);
5748 set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
5751 store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
5753 else
5754 store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, 0, 0, mode, exp, type, alias_set,
5755 false);
5758 /* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
5759 TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
5760 safe_from_p has been called.
5761 CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
5762 SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
5763 may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
5764 which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
5766 static void
5767 store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
5769 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
5770 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5771 HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
5772 #endif
5774 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
5776 case RECORD_TYPE:
5777 case UNION_TYPE:
5778 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
5780 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5781 tree field, value;
5783 /* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
5784 if (size == 0 || cleared)
5785 cleared = 1;
5786 /* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
5787 else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
5788 || TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
5789 && ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5790 /* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
5792 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5793 cleared = 1;
5796 /* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
5797 set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
5798 a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
5799 this probably loses. */
5800 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
5801 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
5803 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
5804 cleared = 1;
5807 /* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
5808 if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
5809 the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
5810 register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
5811 clear_storage can't handle this case. */
5812 else if (size > 0
5813 && (((int)VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
5814 != fields_length (type))
5815 || mostly_zeros_p (exp))
5816 && (!REG_P (target)
5817 || ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
5818 == size)))
5820 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
5821 cleared = 1;
5824 if (REG_P (target) && !cleared)
5825 emit_clobber (target);
5827 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
5828 corresponding field of TARGET. */
5829 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
5831 enum machine_mode mode;
5832 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
5833 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
5834 tree offset;
5835 rtx to_rtx = target;
5837 /* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
5838 structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
5839 if (field == 0)
5840 continue;
5842 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
5843 continue;
5845 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
5846 bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
5847 else
5848 bitsize = -1;
5850 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
5851 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
5852 mode = VOIDmode;
5854 offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
5855 if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
5856 && host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
5858 bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
5859 offset = 0;
5861 else
5862 bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
5864 if (offset)
5866 enum machine_mode address_mode;
5867 rtx offset_rtx;
5869 offset
5870 = SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
5871 make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
5872 target));
5874 offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
5875 gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
5877 address_mode
5878 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (to_rtx));
5879 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
5880 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
5882 to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
5883 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
5886 #ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
5887 /* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
5888 word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
5889 word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
5890 function initializations in a form that the optimizers
5891 can understand. */
5892 if (REG_P (target)
5893 && bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
5894 && bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
5895 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
5896 && TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
5897 && exp_size >= 0
5898 && bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
5900 tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
5902 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
5904 type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
5905 (word_mode, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
5906 value = fold_convert (type, value);
5909 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
5910 value
5911 = fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
5912 build_int_cst (type,
5913 BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
5914 bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
5915 mode = word_mode;
5917 #endif
5919 if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
5920 && DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
5922 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
5923 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
5926 store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
5927 value, type, cleared,
5928 get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
5930 break;
5932 case ARRAY_TYPE:
5934 tree value, index;
5935 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
5936 int need_to_clear;
5937 tree domain;
5938 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
5939 int const_bounds_p;
5940 HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
5941 HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
5943 domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
5944 const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
5945 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
5946 && host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
5947 && host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
5949 /* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
5950 if (const_bounds_p)
5952 minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
5953 maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
5956 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
5957 the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
5958 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
5959 if (cleared)
5960 need_to_clear = 0;
5961 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
5962 need_to_clear = 1;
5963 else
5965 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
5966 tree index, value;
5967 HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
5968 need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
5970 /* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
5971 mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
5972 is also needed to check for missing elements. */
5973 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
5975 HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
5977 if (need_to_clear)
5978 break;
5980 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
5982 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
5983 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
5985 if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
5986 || ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
5988 need_to_clear = 1;
5989 break;
5992 this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
5993 - tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
5995 else
5996 this_node_count = 1;
5998 count += this_node_count;
5999 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6000 zero_count += this_node_count;
6003 /* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
6004 elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
6005 75%. */
6006 if (! need_to_clear
6007 && (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
6008 || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
6009 need_to_clear = 1;
6012 if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
6014 if (REG_P (target))
6015 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6016 else
6017 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6018 cleared = 1;
6021 if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
6022 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6023 emit_clobber (target);
6025 /* Store each element of the constructor into the
6026 corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
6027 elements. */
6028 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
6030 enum machine_mode mode;
6031 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6032 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6033 rtx xtarget = target;
6035 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6036 continue;
6038 mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6039 if (mode == BLKmode)
6040 bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6041 ? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6042 : -1);
6043 else
6044 bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6046 if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
6048 tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
6049 tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
6050 rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
6051 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
6052 tree position;
6054 /* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
6055 if (const_bounds_p
6056 && host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
6057 && host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
6058 && (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
6059 hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
6060 count = hi - lo + 1,
6061 (!MEM_P (target)
6062 || count <= 2
6063 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
6064 && (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
6065 <= 40 * 8)))))
6067 lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
6068 for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
6070 bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
6072 if (MEM_P (target)
6073 && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6074 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6075 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6077 target = copy_rtx (target);
6078 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6081 store_constructor_field
6082 (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
6083 get_alias_set (elttype));
6086 else
6088 rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
6089 rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
6090 tree exit_cond;
6092 expand_normal (hi_index);
6094 index = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
6095 VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
6096 index_r = gen_reg_rtx (promote_decl_mode (index, NULL));
6097 SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
6098 store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0, false);
6100 /* Build the head of the loop. */
6101 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
6102 emit_label (loop_start);
6104 /* Assign value to element index. */
6105 position =
6106 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6107 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6108 TREE_TYPE (index),
6109 index,
6110 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6112 position =
6113 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
6114 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6115 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6117 pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
6118 xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
6119 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6120 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6121 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
6122 store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
6123 bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6124 else
6125 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6127 /* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
6128 exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
6129 index, hi_index);
6130 jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end, -1);
6132 /* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
6133 the loop. */
6134 expand_assignment (index,
6135 build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6136 index, integer_one_node),
6137 false);
6139 emit_jump (loop_start);
6141 /* Build the end of the loop. */
6142 emit_label (loop_end);
6145 else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
6146 || ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
6148 tree position;
6150 if (index == 0)
6151 index = ssize_int (1);
6153 if (minelt)
6154 index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
6155 fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
6156 TREE_TYPE (index),
6157 index,
6158 TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
6160 position =
6161 size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
6162 fold_convert (ssizetype,
6163 TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
6164 xtarget = offset_address (target,
6165 expand_normal (position),
6166 highest_pow2_factor (position));
6167 xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
6168 store_expr (value, xtarget, 0, false);
6170 else
6172 if (index != 0)
6173 bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
6174 * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6175 else
6176 bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
6178 if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
6179 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
6180 && TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
6182 target = copy_rtx (target);
6183 MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
6185 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
6186 type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
6189 break;
6192 case VECTOR_TYPE:
6194 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
6195 constructor_elt *ce;
6196 int i;
6197 int need_to_clear;
6198 int icode = 0;
6199 tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
6200 int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
6201 enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
6202 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
6203 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
6204 rtvec vector = NULL;
6205 unsigned n_elts;
6206 alias_set_type alias;
6208 gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
6210 n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
6211 if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
6213 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
6215 icode = (int) optab_handler (vec_init_optab, mode);
6216 if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
6218 unsigned int i;
6220 vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
6221 for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
6222 RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
6226 /* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
6227 clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
6228 constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
6229 if (cleared)
6230 need_to_clear = 0;
6231 else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
6232 need_to_clear = 1;
6233 else
6235 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
6236 tree value;
6238 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
6240 int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
6241 (int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
6242 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
6243 TYPE_SIZE (elttype)), 1);
6245 count += n_elts_here;
6246 if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
6247 zero_count += n_elts_here;
6250 /* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
6251 or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
6252 need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
6255 if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
6257 if (REG_P (target))
6258 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6259 else
6260 clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6261 cleared = 1;
6264 /* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
6265 if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
6266 emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
6268 if (MEM_P (target))
6269 alias = MEM_ALIAS_SET (target);
6270 else
6271 alias = get_alias_set (elttype);
6273 /* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
6274 element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
6275 for (idx = 0, i = 0;
6276 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
6277 idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
6279 HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
6280 tree value = ce->value;
6282 bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
6283 if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
6284 continue;
6286 if (ce->index)
6287 eltpos = tree_low_cst (ce->index, 1);
6288 else
6289 eltpos = i;
6291 if (vector)
6293 /* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
6294 vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
6295 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
6296 RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
6297 = expand_normal (value);
6299 else
6301 enum machine_mode value_mode =
6302 TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
6303 ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
6304 : eltmode;
6305 bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
6306 store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6307 value_mode, value, type,
6308 cleared, alias);
6312 if (vector)
6313 emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
6314 (target,
6315 gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
6316 break;
6319 default:
6320 gcc_unreachable ();
6324 /* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
6325 into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
6326 BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
6327 If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
6329 BITREGION_START is bitpos of the first bitfield in this region.
6330 BITREGION_END is the bitpos of the ending bitfield in this region.
6331 These two fields are 0, if the C++ memory model does not apply,
6332 or we are not interested in keeping track of bitfield regions.
6334 Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
6335 return.
6337 TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
6339 ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
6340 (in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
6341 reference to the containing structure.
6343 If NONTEMPORAL is true, try generating a nontemporal store. */
6345 static rtx
6346 store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
6347 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_start,
6348 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitregion_end,
6349 enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, tree type,
6350 alias_set_type alias_set, bool nontemporal)
6352 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
6353 return const0_rtx;
6355 /* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
6356 side-effects. */
6357 if (bitsize == 0)
6358 return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
6360 /* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
6361 in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
6362 MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
6363 alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
6364 the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
6365 call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
6366 that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
6367 very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
6368 than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
6369 cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
6370 twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
6372 if (mode == BLKmode
6373 && (REG_P (target) || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
6375 rtx object = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
6376 rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
6378 if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
6379 emit_move_insn (object, target);
6381 store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos,
6382 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6383 mode, exp, type, MEM_ALIAS_SET (blk_object), nontemporal);
6385 emit_move_insn (target, object);
6387 /* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
6388 return blk_object;
6391 if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
6393 /* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
6395 gcc_assert (!bitpos);
6396 return store_expr (exp, target, 0, nontemporal);
6399 /* If the structure is in a register or if the component
6400 is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
6401 Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
6403 if (mode == VOIDmode
6404 || (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
6405 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
6406 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
6407 || REG_P (target)
6408 || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
6409 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
6410 store it as a bit field. */
6411 || (mode != BLKmode
6412 && ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6413 || bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
6414 && SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
6415 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
6416 || (bitsize >= 0 && mode != BLKmode
6417 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > bitsize)
6418 /* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
6419 RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
6420 operations. */
6421 || (bitsize >= 0
6422 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
6423 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0)
6424 /* If we are expanding a MEM_REF of a non-BLKmode non-addressable
6425 decl we must use bitfield operations. */
6426 || (bitsize >= 0
6427 && TREE_CODE (exp) == MEM_REF
6428 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
6429 && DECL_P (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
6430 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),0 ))
6431 && DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)) != BLKmode))
6433 rtx temp;
6434 gimple nop_def;
6436 /* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
6437 implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
6438 the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
6439 particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
6440 C front end. */
6441 nop_def = get_def_for_expr (exp, NOP_EXPR);
6442 if (nop_def)
6444 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
6445 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
6446 && TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
6447 && bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
6449 tree op = gimple_assign_rhs1 (nop_def);
6450 type = TREE_TYPE (op);
6451 if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
6452 exp = op;
6456 temp = expand_normal (exp);
6458 /* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
6459 we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
6460 low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
6461 big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
6462 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
6463 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
6464 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
6465 temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
6466 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp)) - bitsize,
6467 NULL_RTX, 1);
6469 /* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
6470 MODE. */
6471 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
6472 && mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
6473 temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
6475 /* If the modes of TEMP and TARGET are both BLKmode, both
6476 must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
6477 boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. Likewise
6478 for a BLKmode-like TARGET. */
6479 if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode
6480 && (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
6481 || (MEM_P (target)
6482 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (target)) == MODE_INT
6483 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6484 && (bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)))
6486 gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
6487 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
6489 target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6490 emit_block_move (target, temp,
6491 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
6492 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
6493 BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
6495 return const0_rtx;
6498 /* Store the value in the bitfield. */
6499 store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
6500 bitregion_start, bitregion_end,
6501 mode, temp);
6503 return const0_rtx;
6505 else
6507 /* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
6508 rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
6510 if (to_rtx == target)
6511 to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
6513 if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
6514 set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
6516 return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0, nontemporal);
6520 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
6521 an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
6522 codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
6524 We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
6525 bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
6526 If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
6527 giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
6528 This offset is in addition to the bit position.
6529 If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
6531 If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
6532 we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
6534 If the field is a non-BLKmode bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode.
6535 Otherwise, it is a mode that can be used to access the field.
6537 If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
6538 BLKmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
6539 this case, but the address of the object can be found.
6541 If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
6542 look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
6543 the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
6544 possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
6545 the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
6546 normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
6547 the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
6548 associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
6549 on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
6550 by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
6551 is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
6552 and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
6553 the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
6555 tree
6556 get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
6557 HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
6558 enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
6559 int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
6561 tree size_tree = 0;
6562 enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
6563 bool blkmode_bitfield = false;
6564 tree offset = size_zero_node;
6565 double_int bit_offset = double_int_zero;
6567 /* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
6568 outermost expression. */
6569 *pbitsize = -1;
6570 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
6572 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6573 size_tree = DECL_SIZE (field);
6574 if (!DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
6575 mode = DECL_MODE (field);
6576 else if (DECL_MODE (field) == BLKmode)
6577 blkmode_bitfield = true;
6578 else if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
6579 && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
6580 /* Volatile bitfields should be accessed in the mode of the
6581 field's type, not the mode computed based on the bit
6582 size. */
6583 mode = TYPE_MODE (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (field));
6585 *punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (field);
6587 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
6589 size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6590 *punsignedp = (! INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6591 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
6593 /* For vector types, with the correct size of access, use the mode of
6594 inner type. */
6595 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == VECTOR_TYPE
6596 && TREE_TYPE (exp) == TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6597 && tree_int_cst_equal (size_tree, TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))))
6598 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6600 else
6602 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6603 *punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6605 if (mode == BLKmode)
6606 size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6607 else
6608 *pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
6611 if (size_tree != 0)
6613 if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
6614 mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
6615 else
6616 *pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
6619 /* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
6620 and find the ultimate containing object. */
6621 while (1)
6623 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6625 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6626 bit_offset
6627 = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6628 tree_to_double_int (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)));
6629 break;
6631 case COMPONENT_REF:
6633 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6634 tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
6636 /* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
6637 This should only happen when folding expressions made during
6638 type construction. */
6639 if (this_offset == 0)
6640 break;
6642 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
6643 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6644 tree_to_double_int
6645 (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field)));
6647 /* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
6649 break;
6651 case ARRAY_REF:
6652 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6654 tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6655 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
6656 tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
6658 /* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
6659 First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
6660 index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
6661 the array element. */
6662 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
6663 index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
6664 index, low_bound);
6666 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6667 size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
6668 fold_convert (sizetype, index),
6669 unit_size));
6671 break;
6673 case REALPART_EXPR:
6674 break;
6676 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6677 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset,
6678 uhwi_to_double_int (*pbitsize));
6679 break;
6681 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6682 if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
6683 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6684 > TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
6685 && (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
6686 < BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
6687 && (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
6688 || TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
6689 goto done;
6690 break;
6692 case MEM_REF:
6693 /* Hand back the decl for MEM[&decl, off]. */
6694 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR)
6696 tree off = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6697 if (!integer_zerop (off))
6699 double_int boff, coff = mem_ref_offset (exp);
6700 boff = double_int_lshift (coff,
6701 BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6702 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6703 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, true);
6704 bit_offset = double_int_add (bit_offset, boff);
6706 exp = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
6708 goto done;
6710 default:
6711 goto done;
6714 /* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
6715 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
6716 *pvolatilep = 1;
6718 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6720 done:
6722 /* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
6723 constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
6724 this conversion. */
6725 if (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST)
6727 double_int tem = tree_to_double_int (offset);
6728 tem = double_int_sext (tem, TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype));
6729 tem = double_int_lshift (tem,
6730 BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6731 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6732 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, true);
6733 tem = double_int_add (tem, bit_offset);
6734 if (double_int_fits_in_shwi_p (tem))
6736 *pbitpos = double_int_to_shwi (tem);
6737 *poffset = offset = NULL_TREE;
6741 /* Otherwise, split it up. */
6742 if (offset)
6744 /* Avoid returning a negative bitpos as this may wreak havoc later. */
6745 if (double_int_negative_p (bit_offset))
6747 double_int mask
6748 = double_int_mask (BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6749 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT));
6750 double_int tem = double_int_and_not (bit_offset, mask);
6751 /* TEM is the bitpos rounded to BITS_PER_UNIT towards -Inf.
6752 Subtract it to BIT_OFFSET and add it (scaled) to OFFSET. */
6753 bit_offset = double_int_sub (bit_offset, tem);
6754 tem = double_int_rshift (tem,
6755 BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
6756 ? 3 : exact_log2 (BITS_PER_UNIT),
6757 HOST_BITS_PER_DOUBLE_INT, true);
6758 offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
6759 double_int_to_tree (sizetype, tem));
6762 *pbitpos = double_int_to_shwi (bit_offset);
6763 *poffset = offset;
6766 /* We can use BLKmode for a byte-aligned BLKmode bitfield. */
6767 if (mode == VOIDmode
6768 && blkmode_bitfield
6769 && (*pbitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
6770 && (*pbitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0)
6771 *pmode = BLKmode;
6772 else
6773 *pmode = mode;
6775 return exp;
6778 /* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, an ARRAY_REF or an
6779 ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for whether EXP or any nested component-refs within
6780 EXP is marked as PACKED. */
6782 bool
6783 contains_packed_reference (const_tree exp)
6785 bool packed_p = false;
6787 while (1)
6789 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
6791 case COMPONENT_REF:
6793 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6794 packed_p = DECL_PACKED (field)
6795 || TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (field))
6796 || TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
6797 if (packed_p)
6798 goto done;
6800 break;
6802 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6803 case ARRAY_REF:
6804 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6805 case REALPART_EXPR:
6806 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
6807 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6808 break;
6810 default:
6811 goto done;
6813 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
6815 done:
6816 return packed_p;
6819 /* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
6820 of EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6822 tree
6823 array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
6825 tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
6826 tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6827 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6829 /* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
6830 in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
6831 if (aligned_size)
6833 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6834 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6835 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
6836 aligned_size = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_size);
6837 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
6838 size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
6841 /* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
6842 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6843 else
6844 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
6847 /* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
6848 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6850 tree
6851 array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
6853 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6855 /* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
6856 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
6857 return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6859 /* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
6860 substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6861 if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
6862 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6864 /* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
6865 return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
6868 /* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
6869 EXP, an ARRAY_REF or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF. */
6871 tree
6872 array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
6874 tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
6876 /* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
6877 for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
6878 if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
6879 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
6881 /* Otherwise fail. */
6882 return NULL_TREE;
6885 /* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
6886 by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
6888 tree
6889 component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
6891 tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
6892 tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
6893 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
6895 /* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
6896 in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
6897 value. */
6898 if (aligned_offset)
6900 /* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
6901 sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
6902 if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
6903 aligned_offset = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype, aligned_offset);
6904 return size_binop_loc (loc, MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
6905 size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field)
6906 / BITS_PER_UNIT));
6909 /* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
6910 any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
6911 else
6912 return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
6915 /* Alignment in bits the TARGET of an assignment may be assumed to have. */
6917 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6918 target_align (const_tree target)
6920 /* We might have a chain of nested references with intermediate misaligning
6921 bitfields components, so need to recurse to find out. */
6923 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT this_align, outer_align;
6925 switch (TREE_CODE (target))
6927 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
6928 return 1;
6930 case COMPONENT_REF:
6931 this_align = DECL_ALIGN (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
6932 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6933 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6935 case ARRAY_REF:
6936 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
6937 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6938 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6939 return MIN (this_align, outer_align);
6941 CASE_CONVERT:
6942 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
6943 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
6944 this_align = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6945 outer_align = target_align (TREE_OPERAND (target, 0));
6946 return MAX (this_align, outer_align);
6948 default:
6949 return TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (target));
6954 /* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
6955 an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
6956 This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
6957 returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
6959 The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
6962 force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
6964 rtx op1, op2;
6965 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
6966 rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
6967 enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
6969 /* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
6970 if (code == SUBREG
6971 && !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
6972 && !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
6974 value
6975 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
6976 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6977 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
6978 NULL_RTX)),
6979 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
6980 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
6981 code = GET_CODE (value);
6984 /* Check for a PIC address load. */
6985 if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
6986 && XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
6987 && (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
6988 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
6989 || GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
6991 if (!subtarget)
6992 subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
6993 emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
6994 return subtarget;
6997 if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
6999 op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
7000 if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
7001 subtarget = 0;
7002 if (code == MINUS && CONST_INT_P (op2))
7004 code = PLUS;
7005 op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
7008 /* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
7009 operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
7010 case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
7011 constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
7012 register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
7013 creating another one around this addition. */
7014 if (code == PLUS && CONST_INT_P (op2)
7015 && GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
7016 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
7017 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
7018 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
7020 rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
7021 XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
7022 subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7023 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
7024 force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
7025 0), 1), 0),
7026 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7029 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
7030 op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
7031 switch (code)
7033 case MULT:
7034 return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
7035 case DIV:
7036 if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
7037 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7038 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7039 else
7040 return expand_divmod (0,
7041 FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
7042 ? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
7043 GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
7044 case MOD:
7045 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7046 target, 0);
7047 case UDIV:
7048 return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7049 target, 1);
7050 case UMOD:
7051 return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
7052 target, 1);
7053 case ASHIFTRT:
7054 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7055 target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7056 default:
7057 return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
7058 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7061 if (UNARY_P (value))
7063 if (!target)
7064 target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
7065 op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
7066 switch (code)
7068 case ZERO_EXTEND:
7069 case SIGN_EXTEND:
7070 case TRUNCATE:
7071 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
7072 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
7073 convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
7074 return target;
7076 case FIX:
7077 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
7078 expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
7079 return target;
7081 case FLOAT:
7082 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
7083 expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
7084 return target;
7086 default:
7087 return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
7091 #ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
7092 /* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
7093 explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
7094 if (paradoxical_subreg_p (value) && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
7095 value
7096 = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
7097 force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7098 force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
7099 NULL_RTX)),
7100 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
7101 SUBREG_BYTE (value));
7102 #endif
7104 return value;
7107 /* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
7108 EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
7109 call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
7110 for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
7112 It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
7113 searches for optimization opportunities. */
7116 safe_from_p (const_rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
7118 rtx exp_rtl = 0;
7119 int i, nops;
7121 if (x == 0
7122 /* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
7123 have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
7124 (except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
7125 So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
7126 clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
7127 do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
7128 || (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
7129 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
7130 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
7131 || TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
7132 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7133 != INTEGER_CST)
7134 && GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
7135 /* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
7136 || (MEM_P (x)
7137 && (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
7138 || (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
7139 && XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
7140 return 1;
7142 /* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
7143 find the underlying pseudo. */
7144 if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
7146 x = SUBREG_REG (x);
7147 if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7148 return 0;
7151 /* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
7152 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
7154 case tcc_declaration:
7155 exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
7156 break;
7158 case tcc_constant:
7159 return 1;
7161 case tcc_exceptional:
7162 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
7164 while (1)
7166 if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
7167 return 0;
7168 exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
7169 if (!exp)
7170 return 1;
7171 if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
7172 return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
7175 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
7177 constructor_elt *ce;
7178 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
7180 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce)
7181 if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
7182 || !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
7183 return 0;
7184 return 1;
7186 else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
7187 return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
7188 else
7189 return 0;
7191 case tcc_statement:
7192 /* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
7193 DECL_EXPR. */
7194 return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
7195 || TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
7196 || !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
7197 || safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
7199 case tcc_binary:
7200 case tcc_comparison:
7201 if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
7202 return 0;
7203 /* Fall through. */
7205 case tcc_unary:
7206 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7208 case tcc_expression:
7209 case tcc_reference:
7210 case tcc_vl_exp:
7211 /* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
7212 the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
7213 both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
7214 expression recursively. */
7216 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7218 case ADDR_EXPR:
7219 /* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
7220 Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
7221 if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
7222 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
7223 || safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
7224 return 1;
7226 /* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
7227 the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
7228 very rare. */
7229 exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7230 if (DECL_P (exp))
7232 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
7233 || !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
7234 return 0;
7235 else
7236 exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
7238 break;
7240 case MEM_REF:
7241 if (MEM_P (x)
7242 && alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
7243 get_alias_set (exp)))
7244 return 0;
7245 break;
7247 case CALL_EXPR:
7248 /* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
7249 all of memory. */
7250 if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7251 || MEM_P (x))
7252 return 0;
7253 break;
7255 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
7256 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
7257 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
7258 gcc_unreachable ();
7260 case SAVE_EXPR:
7261 return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
7263 default:
7264 break;
7267 /* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
7268 if (exp_rtl)
7269 break;
7271 nops = TREE_OPERAND_LENGTH (exp);
7272 for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
7273 if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
7274 && ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
7275 return 0;
7277 break;
7279 case tcc_type:
7280 /* Should never get a type here. */
7281 gcc_unreachable ();
7284 /* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
7285 with it. */
7286 if (exp_rtl)
7288 if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
7290 exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
7291 if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
7292 && REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
7293 return 0;
7296 /* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
7297 are memory and they conflict. */
7298 return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
7299 || (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
7300 && true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x)));
7303 /* If we reach here, it is safe. */
7304 return 1;
7308 /* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
7309 This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
7311 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7312 highest_pow2_factor (const_tree exp)
7314 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
7316 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7318 case INTEGER_CST:
7319 /* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
7320 HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
7321 We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
7322 a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
7323 erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
7324 later ICE. */
7325 if (TREE_OVERFLOW (exp))
7326 return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7327 else
7329 /* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
7330 we don't care about the upper bits. */
7331 c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
7332 c0 &= -c0;
7333 return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
7335 break;
7337 case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
7338 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7339 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7340 return MIN (c0, c1);
7342 case MULT_EXPR:
7343 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7344 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7345 return c0 * c1;
7347 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
7348 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
7349 if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
7350 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
7352 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7353 c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
7354 return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
7356 break;
7358 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
7359 /* The highest power of two of a bit-and expression is the maximum of
7360 that of its operands. We typically get here for a complex LHS and
7361 a constant negative power of two on the RHS to force an explicit
7362 alignment, so don't bother looking at the LHS. */
7363 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7365 CASE_CONVERT:
7366 case SAVE_EXPR:
7367 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
7369 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
7370 return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7372 case COND_EXPR:
7373 c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7374 c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
7375 return MIN (c0, c1);
7377 default:
7378 break;
7381 return 1;
7384 /* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
7385 taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
7386 type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
7387 the structure gives the alignment. */
7389 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7390 highest_pow2_factor_for_target (const_tree target, const_tree exp)
7392 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT talign = target_align (target) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
7393 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
7395 return MAX (factor, talign);
7398 /* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
7399 expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
7400 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
7401 MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
7403 static void
7404 expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
7405 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7407 if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
7408 target = 0;
7409 if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
7411 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7412 *op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
7414 else
7416 /* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
7417 temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
7418 if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
7419 exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
7420 *op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
7421 *op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
7426 /* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
7427 output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
7429 static rtx
7430 expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
7432 rtx mem;
7434 mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
7435 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7436 mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
7437 return mem;
7440 /* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
7441 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7443 static rtx
7444 expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7445 enum expand_modifier modifier, addr_space_t as)
7447 rtx result, subtarget;
7448 tree inner, offset;
7449 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
7450 int volatilep, unsignedp;
7451 enum machine_mode mode1;
7453 /* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
7454 we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
7455 at top level. */
7456 /* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
7457 generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
7458 exception here is STRING_CST. */
7459 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
7461 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
7462 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7463 result = force_operand (result, target);
7464 return result;
7467 /* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
7468 switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
7470 case INDIRECT_REF:
7471 /* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
7472 return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
7474 case MEM_REF:
7476 tree tem = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7477 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
7478 tem = fold_build_pointer_plus (tem, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
7479 return expand_expr (tem, target, tmode, modifier);
7482 case CONST_DECL:
7483 /* Expand the initializer like constants above. */
7484 result = XEXP (expand_expr_constant (DECL_INITIAL (exp),
7485 0, modifier), 0);
7486 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7487 result = force_operand (result, target);
7488 return result;
7490 case REALPART_EXPR:
7491 /* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
7492 the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
7493 offset = 0;
7494 bitpos = 0;
7495 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7496 break;
7498 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
7499 /* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
7500 The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
7501 scalar type. */
7502 offset = 0;
7503 bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7504 inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
7505 break;
7507 default:
7508 /* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
7509 expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
7510 example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Expand the rtl of
7511 CONSTRUCTORs too, which should yield a memory reference for the
7512 constructor's contents. Assume language specific tree nodes can
7513 be expanded in some interesting way. */
7514 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (exp) < LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE);
7515 if (DECL_P (exp)
7516 || TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
7517 || TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR)
7519 result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
7520 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7521 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
7523 /* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
7524 marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
7525 or a tree optimizer bug. */
7527 if (TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7528 && ! MEM_P (result)
7529 && ! targetm.calls.allocate_stack_slots_for_args())
7531 error ("local frame unavailable (naked function?)");
7532 return result;
7534 else
7535 gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
7536 result = XEXP (result, 0);
7538 /* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
7539 if (DECL_P (exp) && !TREE_USED (exp) == 0)
7541 assemble_external (exp);
7542 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
7545 if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7546 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7547 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7548 result = force_operand (result, target);
7549 return result;
7552 /* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
7553 we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
7554 handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
7555 they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
7556 (they actually exist only for that purpose). */
7557 inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
7558 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
7559 break;
7562 /* We must have made progress. */
7563 gcc_assert (inner != exp);
7565 subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7566 /* For VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, where the outer alignment is bigger than
7567 inner alignment, force the inner to be sufficiently aligned. */
7568 if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (inner)
7569 && TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) < TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7571 inner = copy_node (inner);
7572 TREE_TYPE (inner) = copy_node (TREE_TYPE (inner));
7573 TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7574 TYPE_USER_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (inner)) = 1;
7576 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier, as);
7578 if (offset)
7580 rtx tmp;
7582 if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
7583 result = force_operand (result, NULL);
7584 tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, tmode,
7585 modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7586 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_NORMAL);
7588 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7589 tmp = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, tmp, as);
7591 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7592 result = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, tmode, result, tmp);
7593 else
7595 subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
7596 result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
7597 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
7601 if (bitpos)
7603 /* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
7604 of such an object. */
7605 gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
7607 result = plus_constant (result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
7608 if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
7609 result = force_operand (result, target);
7612 return result;
7615 /* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
7616 The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
7618 static rtx
7619 expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7620 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7622 addr_space_t as = ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC;
7623 enum machine_mode address_mode = Pmode;
7624 enum machine_mode pointer_mode = ptr_mode;
7625 enum machine_mode rmode;
7626 rtx result;
7628 /* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
7629 if (tmode == VOIDmode)
7630 tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
7632 if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
7634 as = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
7635 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
7636 pointer_mode = targetm.addr_space.pointer_mode (as);
7639 /* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
7640 like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
7641 the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
7642 if (tmode != address_mode && tmode != pointer_mode)
7643 tmode = address_mode;
7645 result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
7646 tmode, modifier, as);
7648 /* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
7649 strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
7650 that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
7651 rmode = GET_MODE (result);
7652 if (rmode == VOIDmode)
7653 rmode = tmode;
7654 if (rmode != tmode)
7655 result = convert_memory_address_addr_space (tmode, result, as);
7657 return result;
7660 /* Generate code for computing CONSTRUCTOR EXP.
7661 An rtx for the computed value is returned. If AVOID_TEMP_MEM
7662 is TRUE, instead of creating a temporary variable in memory
7663 NULL is returned and the caller needs to handle it differently. */
7665 static rtx
7666 expand_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, enum expand_modifier modifier,
7667 bool avoid_temp_mem)
7669 tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
7670 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7672 /* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
7673 if all of the initializer is zero.
7674 FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
7675 with memset. */
7676 if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
7677 && !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7678 && target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
7679 && all_zeros_p (exp))
7681 clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
7682 return target;
7685 /* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
7686 if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
7687 since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
7688 fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
7689 store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
7690 that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
7691 all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
7693 FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
7694 Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
7695 they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
7696 are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays. */
7697 if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
7698 && ((mode == BLKmode
7699 && ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
7700 || TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
7701 || (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
7702 && (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
7703 (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
7704 TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
7705 && ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
7706 || ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
7707 && TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
7709 rtx constructor;
7711 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7712 return NULL_RTX;
7714 constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
7716 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
7717 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
7718 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
7719 constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
7721 return constructor;
7724 /* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
7725 locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
7726 if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
7727 || GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7729 if (avoid_temp_mem)
7730 return NULL_RTX;
7732 target
7733 = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type, (TYPE_QUALS (type)
7734 | (TREE_READONLY (exp)
7735 * TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
7736 0, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
7739 store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
7740 return target;
7744 /* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
7745 An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
7746 In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
7748 The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
7749 TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7750 the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
7752 If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
7754 If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
7755 result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
7756 Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
7757 TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
7758 the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
7760 Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
7761 probably will not be used.
7763 If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
7764 we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
7765 or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
7766 products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
7767 Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
7768 and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
7770 EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
7771 it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
7772 It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
7773 This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
7775 EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
7776 with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
7777 EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
7779 EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
7780 a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
7781 marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
7782 don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
7783 Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
7784 emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
7786 If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
7787 address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
7788 DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
7789 COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
7790 recursively. */
7793 expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7794 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
7796 rtx ret;
7798 /* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
7799 if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
7800 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK))
7802 ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
7803 return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
7806 /* If this is an expression of some kind and it has an associated line
7807 number, then emit the line number before expanding the expression.
7809 We need to save and restore the file and line information so that
7810 errors discovered during expansion are emitted with the right
7811 information. It would be better of the diagnostic routines
7812 used the file/line information embedded in the tree nodes rather
7813 than globals. */
7814 if (cfun && EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (exp))
7816 location_t saved_location = input_location;
7817 location_t saved_curr_loc = get_curr_insn_source_location ();
7818 tree saved_block = get_curr_insn_block ();
7819 input_location = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
7820 set_curr_insn_source_location (input_location);
7822 /* Record where the insns produced belong. */
7823 set_curr_insn_block (TREE_BLOCK (exp));
7825 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7827 input_location = saved_location;
7828 set_curr_insn_block (saved_block);
7829 set_curr_insn_source_location (saved_curr_loc);
7831 else
7833 ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
7836 return ret;
7840 expand_expr_real_2 (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
7841 enum expand_modifier modifier)
7843 rtx op0, op1, op2, temp;
7844 tree type;
7845 int unsignedp;
7846 enum machine_mode mode;
7847 enum tree_code code = ops->code;
7848 optab this_optab;
7849 rtx subtarget, original_target;
7850 int ignore;
7851 bool reduce_bit_field;
7852 location_t loc = ops->location;
7853 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
7854 #define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field \
7855 ? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
7856 target, \
7857 type) \
7858 : (expr))
7860 type = ops->type;
7861 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
7862 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
7864 treeop0 = ops->op0;
7865 treeop1 = ops->op1;
7866 treeop2 = ops->op2;
7868 /* We should be called only on simple (binary or unary) expressions,
7869 exactly those that are valid in gimple expressions that aren't
7870 GIMPLE_SINGLE_RHS (or invalid). */
7871 gcc_assert (get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_UNARY_RHS
7872 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_BINARY_RHS
7873 || get_gimple_rhs_class (code) == GIMPLE_TERNARY_RHS);
7875 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
7876 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
7877 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
7878 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
7880 /* We should be called only if we need the result. */
7881 gcc_assert (!ignore);
7883 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
7884 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
7885 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
7886 reduce_bit_field = (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
7887 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
7889 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
7890 target = 0;
7892 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
7893 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
7894 original_target = target;
7896 switch (code)
7898 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
7899 case PAREN_EXPR:
7900 CASE_CONVERT:
7901 if (treeop0 == error_mark_node)
7902 return const0_rtx;
7904 if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
7906 tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7908 /* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
7909 anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
7910 if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
7912 rtx result = expand_expr (treeop0, target, tmode,
7913 modifier);
7915 result = copy_rtx (result);
7916 set_mem_attributes (result, type, 0);
7917 return result;
7920 if (target == 0)
7922 if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
7923 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
7924 else
7925 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
7928 if (MEM_P (target))
7929 /* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
7930 store_expr (treeop0,
7931 adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
7932 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
7933 false);
7935 else
7937 gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
7939 /* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
7940 store_field (target,
7941 MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
7942 (treeop0))
7943 * BITS_PER_UNIT),
7944 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
7945 0, 0, 0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), treeop0,
7946 type, 0, false);
7949 /* Return the entire union. */
7950 return target;
7953 if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
7955 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, target, VOIDmode,
7956 modifier);
7958 /* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
7959 a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
7960 have to do the proper extension. */
7961 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != unsignedp
7962 && GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
7963 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
7965 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
7968 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, mode,
7969 modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
7970 if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
7973 /* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
7974 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
7976 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
7977 enum machine_mode inner_mode = GET_MODE (op0);
7979 if (inner_mode == VOIDmode)
7980 inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
7982 if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7983 op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
7984 subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
7985 inner_mode));
7986 else
7987 op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
7988 TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
7991 else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
7992 op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
7994 else if (target == 0)
7995 op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
7996 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
7997 (treeop0)));
7998 else
8000 convert_move (target, op0,
8001 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8002 op0 = target;
8005 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8007 case ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT_EXPR:
8009 tree treeop0_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8010 addr_space_t as_to;
8011 addr_space_t as_from;
8013 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (type));
8014 gcc_assert (POINTER_TYPE_P (treeop0_type));
8016 as_to = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (type));
8017 as_from = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0_type));
8019 /* Conversions between pointers to the same address space should
8020 have been implemented via CONVERT_EXPR / NOP_EXPR. */
8021 gcc_assert (as_to != as_from);
8023 /* Ask target code to handle conversion between pointers
8024 to overlapping address spaces. */
8025 if (targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_to, as_from)
8026 || targetm.addr_space.subset_p (as_from, as_to))
8028 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
8029 op0 = targetm.addr_space.convert (op0, treeop0_type, type);
8030 gcc_assert (op0);
8031 return op0;
8034 /* For disjoint address spaces, converting anything but
8035 a null pointer invokes undefined behaviour. We simply
8036 always return a null pointer here. */
8037 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
8040 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
8041 /* Even though the sizetype mode and the pointer's mode can be different
8042 expand is able to handle this correctly and get the correct result out
8043 of the PLUS_EXPR code. */
8044 /* Make sure to sign-extend the sizetype offset in a POINTER_PLUS_EXPR
8045 if sizetype precision is smaller than pointer precision. */
8046 if (TYPE_PRECISION (sizetype) < TYPE_PRECISION (type))
8047 treeop1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, type,
8048 fold_convert_loc (loc, ssizetype,
8049 treeop1));
8050 case PLUS_EXPR:
8051 /* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
8052 something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
8053 then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
8054 reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
8055 frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
8057 fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
8058 PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
8059 sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
8060 the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
8062 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == PLUS_EXPR
8063 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
8064 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == VAR_DECL
8065 && (DECL_RTL (treeop1) == frame_pointer_rtx
8066 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == stack_pointer_rtx
8067 || DECL_RTL (treeop1) == arg_pointer_rtx))
8069 tree t = treeop1;
8071 treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0);
8072 TREE_OPERAND (treeop0, 0) = t;
8075 /* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
8076 something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
8077 plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
8078 use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
8079 efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
8080 address.
8082 If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
8083 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8084 || (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
8086 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8087 target = 0;
8088 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST
8089 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8090 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop1))
8092 rtx constant_part;
8094 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8095 EXPAND_SUM);
8096 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8097 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8098 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8099 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8100 constant_part
8101 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop0),
8102 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8103 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)));
8104 op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
8105 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8106 op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
8107 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
8110 else if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8111 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
8112 && TREE_CONSTANT (treeop0))
8114 rtx constant_part;
8116 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8117 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
8118 ? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
8119 if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
8121 op1 = expand_expr (treeop1, NULL_RTX,
8122 VOIDmode, modifier);
8123 /* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
8124 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
8125 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8126 return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
8127 goto binop2;
8129 /* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
8130 truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
8131 to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
8132 in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
8133 constant_part
8134 = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (treeop1),
8135 (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
8136 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8137 op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
8138 if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8139 op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
8140 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
8144 /* Use TER to expand pointer addition of a negated value
8145 as pointer subtraction. */
8146 if ((POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8147 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == VECTOR_TYPE
8148 && POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))))
8149 && TREE_CODE (treeop1) == SSA_NAME
8150 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8151 == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop1)))
8153 gimple def = get_def_for_expr (treeop1, NEGATE_EXPR);
8154 if (def)
8156 treeop1 = gimple_assign_rhs1 (def);
8157 code = MINUS_EXPR;
8158 goto do_minus;
8162 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8163 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8164 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8165 zero-extend. */
8166 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8167 || mode != ptr_mode)
8169 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8170 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8171 if (op0 == const0_rtx)
8172 return op1;
8173 if (op1 == const0_rtx)
8174 return op0;
8175 goto binop2;
8178 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8179 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8180 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8182 case MINUS_EXPR:
8183 do_minus:
8184 /* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
8185 symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
8186 are constant. */
8187 /* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
8188 for the sake of an initializer. */
8189 if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8190 && really_constant_p (treeop0)
8191 && really_constant_p (treeop1))
8193 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8194 NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8196 /* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
8197 the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
8198 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8199 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1)));
8200 else
8201 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
8204 /* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
8205 if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
8206 And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
8207 zero-extend. */
8208 if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
8209 || mode != ptr_mode)
8210 goto binop;
8212 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8213 subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
8215 /* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
8216 if (CONST_INT_P (op1))
8218 op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
8219 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
8222 goto binop2;
8224 case WIDEN_MULT_PLUS_EXPR:
8225 case WIDEN_MULT_MINUS_EXPR:
8226 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8227 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8228 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8229 target, unsignedp);
8230 return target;
8232 case WIDEN_MULT_EXPR:
8233 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8234 Thus the following special case checks need only
8235 check the second operand. */
8236 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8238 tree t1 = treeop0;
8239 treeop0 = treeop1;
8240 treeop1 = t1;
8243 /* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
8244 unsigned operand. */
8245 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) != INTEGER_CST
8246 && (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))
8247 != TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))))
8249 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8250 this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
8251 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8252 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8254 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8255 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8256 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8257 else
8258 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0,
8259 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8260 goto binop3;
8263 /* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
8264 else if ((TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST
8265 && int_fits_type_p (treeop1, TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8266 || (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop1))
8267 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0))))
8269 tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
8270 enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
8271 bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
8272 optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
8273 this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
8275 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) != INTEGER_CST)
8277 if (find_widening_optab_handler (this_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8278 != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8280 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1,
8281 EXPAND_NORMAL);
8282 temp = expand_widening_mult (mode, op0, op1, target,
8283 unsignedp, this_optab);
8284 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8286 if (find_widening_optab_handler (other_optab, mode, innermode, 0)
8287 != CODE_FOR_nothing
8288 && innermode == word_mode)
8290 rtx htem, hipart;
8291 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8292 if (TREE_CODE (treeop1) == INTEGER_CST)
8293 op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
8294 expand_normal (treeop1), unsignedp);
8295 else
8296 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8297 temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
8298 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8299 hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
8300 htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
8301 op0, op1, hipart,
8302 zextend_p);
8303 if (htem != hipart)
8304 emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
8305 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8309 treeop0 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop0);
8310 treeop1 = fold_build1 (CONVERT_EXPR, type, treeop1);
8311 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8312 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8314 case FMA_EXPR:
8316 optab opt = fma_optab;
8317 gimple def0, def2;
8319 /* If there is no insn for FMA, emit it as __builtin_fma{,f,l}
8320 call. */
8321 if (optab_handler (fma_optab, mode) == CODE_FOR_nothing)
8323 tree fn = mathfn_built_in (TREE_TYPE (treeop0), BUILT_IN_FMA);
8324 tree call_expr;
8326 gcc_assert (fn != NULL_TREE);
8327 call_expr = build_call_expr (fn, 3, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2);
8328 return expand_builtin (call_expr, target, subtarget, mode, false);
8331 def0 = get_def_for_expr (treeop0, NEGATE_EXPR);
8332 def2 = get_def_for_expr (treeop2, NEGATE_EXPR);
8334 op0 = op2 = NULL;
8336 if (def0 && def2
8337 && optab_handler (fnms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8339 opt = fnms_optab;
8340 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8341 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8343 else if (def0
8344 && optab_handler (fnma_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8346 opt = fnma_optab;
8347 op0 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def0));
8349 else if (def2
8350 && optab_handler (fms_optab, mode) != CODE_FOR_nothing)
8352 opt = fms_optab;
8353 op2 = expand_normal (gimple_assign_rhs1 (def2));
8356 if (op0 == NULL)
8357 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8358 if (op2 == NULL)
8359 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8360 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8362 return expand_ternary_op (TYPE_MODE (type), opt,
8363 op0, op1, op2, target, 0);
8366 case MULT_EXPR:
8367 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8368 below because "expand_mult" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8369 multiplications. */
8370 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8371 goto binop;
8373 /* If first operand is constant, swap them.
8374 Thus the following special case checks need only
8375 check the second operand. */
8376 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == INTEGER_CST)
8378 tree t1 = treeop0;
8379 treeop0 = treeop1;
8380 treeop1 = t1;
8383 /* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
8384 indexed address, for machines that support that. */
8386 if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
8387 && host_integerp (treeop1, 0))
8389 tree exp1 = treeop1;
8391 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget, VOIDmode,
8392 EXPAND_SUM);
8394 if (!REG_P (op0))
8395 op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
8396 if (!REG_P (op0))
8397 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
8399 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
8400 gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
8401 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
8404 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8405 target = 0;
8407 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8408 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
8410 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
8411 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
8412 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
8413 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
8414 case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
8415 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8416 below because "expand_divmod" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8417 divisions. */
8418 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8419 goto binop;
8421 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8422 target = 0;
8423 /* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
8424 then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
8425 where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
8426 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8427 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8428 return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8430 case RDIV_EXPR:
8431 goto binop;
8433 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
8434 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
8435 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
8436 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
8437 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8438 target = 0;
8439 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8440 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8441 return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
8443 case FIXED_CONVERT_EXPR:
8444 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8445 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8446 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8448 if ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) == INTEGER_TYPE
8449 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
8450 || (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type)))
8451 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 1, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8452 else
8453 expand_fixed_convert (target, op0, 0, TYPE_SATURATING (type));
8454 return target;
8456 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8457 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8458 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8459 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8460 expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
8461 return target;
8463 case FLOAT_EXPR:
8464 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8465 if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8466 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8467 /* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
8468 So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
8469 if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
8470 op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)),
8471 op0);
8472 expand_float (target, op0,
8473 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8474 return target;
8476 case NEGATE_EXPR:
8477 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8478 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8479 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8480 target = 0;
8481 temp = expand_unop (mode,
8482 optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type,
8483 optab_default),
8484 op0, target, 0);
8485 gcc_assert (temp);
8486 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8488 case ABS_EXPR:
8489 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8490 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8491 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8492 target = 0;
8494 /* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
8495 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
8496 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
8498 /* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
8499 risk generating incorrect code below. */
8500 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8501 return op0;
8503 return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
8504 safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1));
8506 case MAX_EXPR:
8507 case MIN_EXPR:
8508 target = original_target;
8509 if (target == 0
8510 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8511 || (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
8512 || GET_MODE (target) != mode
8513 || (REG_P (target)
8514 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
8515 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8516 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8517 target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8519 /* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
8520 If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
8521 value. */
8522 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8523 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
8524 OPTAB_WIDEN);
8525 if (temp != 0)
8526 return temp;
8528 /* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
8529 code without it. */
8531 if (! REG_P (target))
8532 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
8534 /* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
8535 if (target != op0 && target == op1)
8537 temp = op0;
8538 op0 = op1;
8539 op1 = temp;
8542 /* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
8543 target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
8544 if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
8545 op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
8548 enum rtx_code comparison_code;
8549 rtx cmpop1 = op1;
8551 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8552 comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
8553 else
8554 comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
8556 /* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
8557 if (op1 == const1_rtx)
8559 /* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
8560 or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
8561 For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
8562 into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
8563 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8564 if (code == MAX_EXPR)
8565 comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
8567 if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
8569 /* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
8570 and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
8571 cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
8572 if (code == MIN_EXPR)
8573 comparison_code = LT;
8575 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8576 /* Use a conditional move if possible. */
8577 if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
8579 rtx insn;
8581 /* ??? Same problem as in expmed.c: emit_conditional_move
8582 forces a stack adjustment via compare_from_rtx, and we
8583 lose the stack adjustment if the sequence we are about
8584 to create is discarded. */
8585 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8587 start_sequence ();
8589 /* Try to emit the conditional move. */
8590 insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
8591 op0, cmpop1, mode,
8592 op0, op1, mode,
8593 unsignedp);
8595 /* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
8596 and return. */
8597 if (insn)
8599 rtx seq = get_insns ();
8600 end_sequence ();
8601 emit_insn (seq);
8602 return target;
8605 /* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
8606 branches. */
8607 end_sequence ();
8609 #endif
8610 if (target != op0)
8611 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
8613 temp = gen_label_rtx ();
8614 do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
8615 unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp,
8616 -1);
8618 emit_move_insn (target, op1);
8619 emit_label (temp);
8620 return target;
8622 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
8623 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8624 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8625 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8626 target = 0;
8627 /* In case we have to reduce the result to bitfield precision
8628 for unsigned bitfield expand this as XOR with a proper constant
8629 instead. */
8630 if (reduce_bit_field && TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8631 temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0,
8632 immed_double_int_const
8633 (double_int_mask (TYPE_PRECISION (type)), mode),
8634 target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8635 else
8636 temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
8637 gcc_assert (temp);
8638 return temp;
8640 /* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
8641 Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
8642 and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
8643 but that is probably not worth while. */
8645 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
8646 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
8647 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
8648 goto binop;
8650 case LROTATE_EXPR:
8651 case RROTATE_EXPR:
8652 gcc_assert (VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type))
8653 || (GET_MODE_PRECISION (TYPE_MODE (type))
8654 == TYPE_PRECISION (type)));
8655 /* fall through */
8657 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
8658 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
8659 /* If this is a fixed-point operation, then we cannot use the code
8660 below because "expand_shift" doesn't support sat/no-sat fixed-point
8661 shifts. */
8662 if (ALL_FIXED_POINT_MODE_P (mode))
8663 goto binop;
8665 if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, treeop1, 1))
8666 subtarget = 0;
8667 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8668 target = 0;
8669 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0, subtarget,
8670 VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8671 temp = expand_variable_shift (code, mode, op0, treeop1, target,
8672 unsignedp);
8673 if (code == LSHIFT_EXPR)
8674 temp = REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8675 return temp;
8677 /* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
8678 the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
8679 case LT_EXPR:
8680 case LE_EXPR:
8681 case GT_EXPR:
8682 case GE_EXPR:
8683 case EQ_EXPR:
8684 case NE_EXPR:
8685 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
8686 case ORDERED_EXPR:
8687 case UNLT_EXPR:
8688 case UNLE_EXPR:
8689 case UNGT_EXPR:
8690 case UNGE_EXPR:
8691 case UNEQ_EXPR:
8692 case LTGT_EXPR:
8693 temp = do_store_flag (ops,
8694 modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
8695 tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8696 if (temp)
8697 return temp;
8699 /* Use a compare and a jump for BLKmode comparisons, or for function
8700 type comparisons is HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare. */
8702 if ((target == 0
8703 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8704 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop0, 1)
8705 || ! safe_from_p (target, treeop1, 1)
8706 /* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
8707 value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
8708 || (!optimize && REG_P (target)
8709 && REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
8710 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
8712 emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
8714 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8715 jumpifnot_1 (code, treeop0, treeop1, op1, -1);
8717 if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) == 1 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8718 emit_move_insn (target, constm1_rtx);
8719 else
8720 emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
8722 emit_label (op1);
8723 return target;
8725 case COMPLEX_EXPR:
8726 /* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
8727 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8728 op1 = expand_normal (treeop1);
8730 if (!target)
8731 target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
8733 /* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
8734 write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
8735 write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
8737 return target;
8739 case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
8741 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8742 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8744 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8745 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
8746 target, unsignedp);
8747 return target;
8750 case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
8751 case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
8752 case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
8754 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8755 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8756 temp = expand_unop (mode, this_optab, op0, target, unsignedp);
8757 gcc_assert (temp);
8758 return temp;
8761 case VEC_LSHIFT_EXPR:
8762 case VEC_RSHIFT_EXPR:
8764 target = expand_vec_shift_expr (ops, target);
8765 return target;
8768 case VEC_UNPACK_HI_EXPR:
8769 case VEC_UNPACK_LO_EXPR:
8771 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8772 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8773 target, unsignedp);
8774 gcc_assert (temp);
8775 return temp;
8778 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_HI_EXPR:
8779 case VEC_UNPACK_FLOAT_LO_EXPR:
8781 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
8782 /* The signedness is determined from input operand. */
8783 temp = expand_widen_pattern_expr
8784 (ops, op0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX,
8785 target, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
8787 gcc_assert (temp);
8788 return temp;
8791 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_HI_EXPR:
8792 case VEC_WIDEN_MULT_LO_EXPR:
8794 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8795 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8797 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8798 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
8799 target, unsignedp);
8800 gcc_assert (target);
8801 return target;
8804 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_HI_EXPR:
8805 case VEC_WIDEN_LSHIFT_LO_EXPR:
8807 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8808 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8810 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8811 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, NULL_RTX,
8812 target, unsignedp);
8813 gcc_assert (target);
8814 return target;
8817 case VEC_PACK_TRUNC_EXPR:
8818 case VEC_PACK_SAT_EXPR:
8819 case VEC_PACK_FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
8820 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0));
8821 goto binop;
8823 case VEC_PERM_EXPR:
8824 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1, target, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8825 op2 = expand_normal (treeop2);
8827 /* Careful here: if the target doesn't support integral vector modes,
8828 a constant selection vector could wind up smooshed into a normal
8829 integral constant. */
8830 if (CONSTANT_P (op2) && GET_CODE (op2) != CONST_VECTOR)
8832 tree sel_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop2);
8833 enum machine_mode vmode
8834 = mode_for_vector (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (sel_type)),
8835 TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (sel_type));
8836 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (vmode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
8837 op2 = simplify_subreg (vmode, op2, TYPE_MODE (sel_type), 0);
8838 gcc_assert (op2 && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_VECTOR);
8840 else
8841 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op2)) == MODE_VECTOR_INT);
8843 temp = expand_vec_perm (mode, op0, op1, op2, target);
8844 gcc_assert (temp);
8845 return temp;
8847 case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
8849 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8850 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8851 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
8852 rtx op2;
8854 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8855 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
8856 target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (ops, op0, op1, op2,
8857 target, unsignedp);
8858 return target;
8861 case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
8863 tree oprnd0 = treeop0;
8864 tree oprnd1 = treeop1;
8865 tree oprnd2 = treeop2;
8866 rtx op2;
8868 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8869 expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8870 op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
8871 temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
8872 target, unsignedp);
8873 gcc_assert (temp);
8874 return temp;
8877 case COND_EXPR:
8878 /* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
8879 conditional jump and is handled in
8880 expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
8881 gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (type));
8883 /* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
8884 are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
8885 a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
8886 for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
8888 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
8889 && !ignore
8890 && TREE_TYPE (treeop1) != void_type_node
8891 && TREE_TYPE (treeop2) != void_type_node);
8893 /* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
8894 if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
8895 intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
8896 temporary. */
8898 if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
8899 && original_target
8900 && safe_from_p (original_target, treeop0, 1)
8901 && GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
8902 #ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
8903 && (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
8904 || REG_P (original_target))
8905 #endif
8906 && !MEM_P (original_target))
8907 temp = original_target;
8908 else
8909 temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
8911 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
8912 NO_DEFER_POP;
8913 op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
8914 op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
8915 jumpifnot (treeop0, op0, -1);
8916 store_expr (treeop1, temp,
8917 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8918 false);
8920 emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
8921 emit_barrier ();
8922 emit_label (op0);
8923 store_expr (treeop2, temp,
8924 modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM,
8925 false);
8927 emit_label (op1);
8928 OK_DEFER_POP;
8929 return temp;
8931 case VEC_COND_EXPR:
8932 target = expand_vec_cond_expr (type, treeop0, treeop1, treeop2, target);
8933 return target;
8935 default:
8936 gcc_unreachable ();
8939 /* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
8940 binop:
8941 expand_operands (treeop0, treeop1,
8942 subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
8943 binop2:
8944 this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type, optab_default);
8945 binop3:
8946 if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
8947 target = 0;
8948 temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
8949 unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
8950 gcc_assert (temp);
8951 /* Bitwise operations do not need bitfield reduction as we expect their
8952 operands being properly truncated. */
8953 if (code == BIT_XOR_EXPR
8954 || code == BIT_AND_EXPR
8955 || code == BIT_IOR_EXPR)
8956 return temp;
8957 return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
8959 #undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
8962 expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
8963 enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
8965 rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
8966 tree type;
8967 int unsignedp;
8968 enum machine_mode mode;
8969 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
8970 rtx subtarget, original_target;
8971 int ignore;
8972 tree context;
8973 bool reduce_bit_field;
8974 location_t loc = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
8975 struct separate_ops ops;
8976 tree treeop0, treeop1, treeop2;
8977 tree ssa_name = NULL_TREE;
8978 gimple g;
8980 type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
8981 mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
8982 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
8984 treeop0 = treeop1 = treeop2 = NULL_TREE;
8985 if (!VL_EXP_CLASS_P (exp))
8986 switch (TREE_CODE_LENGTH (code))
8988 default:
8989 case 3: treeop2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
8990 case 2: treeop1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
8991 case 1: treeop0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
8992 case 0: break;
8994 ops.code = code;
8995 ops.type = type;
8996 ops.op0 = treeop0;
8997 ops.op1 = treeop1;
8998 ops.op2 = treeop2;
8999 ops.location = loc;
9001 ignore = (target == const0_rtx
9002 || ((CONVERT_EXPR_CODE_P (code)
9003 || code == COND_EXPR || code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
9004 && TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
9006 /* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
9007 result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
9008 which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
9009 reduce_bit_field = (!ignore
9010 && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
9011 && GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type));
9013 /* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
9014 if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
9015 is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
9016 not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
9017 is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
9019 if (ignore)
9021 if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
9022 return const0_rtx;
9024 /* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
9025 don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
9026 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
9027 && TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
9028 && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
9029 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
9031 temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
9032 if (MEM_P (temp))
9033 copy_to_reg (temp);
9034 return const0_rtx;
9037 if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
9038 || code == COMPONENT_REF || code == INDIRECT_REF)
9039 return expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
9040 modifier);
9042 else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
9043 || TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
9044 || code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
9046 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9047 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9048 return const0_rtx;
9050 else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
9052 expand_expr (treeop0, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9053 expand_expr (treeop1, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9054 expand_expr (treeop2, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
9055 return const0_rtx;
9058 target = 0;
9061 if (reduce_bit_field && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9062 target = 0;
9064 /* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
9065 subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
9066 original_target = target;
9068 switch (code)
9070 case LABEL_DECL:
9072 tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
9074 temp = label_rtx (exp);
9075 temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
9077 if (function != current_function_decl
9078 && function != 0)
9079 LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
9081 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
9082 return temp;
9085 case SSA_NAME:
9086 /* ??? ivopts calls expander, without any preparation from
9087 out-of-ssa. So fake instructions as if this was an access to the
9088 base variable. This unnecessarily allocates a pseudo, see how we can
9089 reuse it, if partition base vars have it set already. */
9090 if (!currently_expanding_to_rtl)
9091 return expand_expr_real_1 (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), target, tmode, modifier,
9092 NULL);
9094 g = get_gimple_for_ssa_name (exp);
9095 /* For EXPAND_INITIALIZER try harder to get something simpler. */
9096 if (g == NULL
9097 && modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9098 && !SSA_NAME_IS_DEFAULT_DEF (exp)
9099 && (optimize || DECL_IGNORED_P (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp)))
9100 && stmt_is_replaceable_p (SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp)))
9101 g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (exp);
9102 if (g)
9103 return expand_expr_real (gimple_assign_rhs_to_tree (g), target, tmode,
9104 modifier, NULL);
9106 ssa_name = exp;
9107 decl_rtl = get_rtx_for_ssa_name (ssa_name);
9108 exp = SSA_NAME_VAR (ssa_name);
9109 goto expand_decl_rtl;
9111 case PARM_DECL:
9112 case VAR_DECL:
9113 /* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
9114 but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
9115 if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
9116 && COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9117 && (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
9118 layout_decl (exp, 0);
9120 /* ... fall through ... */
9122 case FUNCTION_DECL:
9123 case RESULT_DECL:
9124 decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
9125 expand_decl_rtl:
9126 gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
9127 decl_rtl = copy_rtx (decl_rtl);
9128 /* Record writes to register variables. */
9129 if (modifier == EXPAND_WRITE
9130 && REG_P (decl_rtl)
9131 && HARD_REGISTER_P (decl_rtl))
9132 add_to_hard_reg_set (&crtl->asm_clobbers,
9133 GET_MODE (decl_rtl), REGNO (decl_rtl));
9135 /* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
9136 a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
9137 definition. */
9138 if (! TREE_USED (exp))
9140 assemble_external (exp);
9141 TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
9144 /* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
9145 temp = 0;
9147 /* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
9148 been lowered by this point. */
9149 context = decl_function_context (exp);
9150 gcc_assert (!context
9151 || context == current_function_decl
9152 || TREE_STATIC (exp)
9153 || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)
9154 /* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
9155 || TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
9157 /* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
9158 from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
9159 See expand_decl. */
9161 if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
9162 temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
9164 /* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and the
9165 address is not valid, get the address into a register. */
9167 else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9169 if (alt_rtl)
9170 *alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
9171 decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
9172 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9173 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9174 && !memory_address_addr_space_p (DECL_MODE (exp),
9175 XEXP (decl_rtl, 0),
9176 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (decl_rtl)))
9177 temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
9178 copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
9181 /* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
9182 if the address is a register. */
9183 if (temp != 0)
9185 if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
9186 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
9188 return temp;
9191 /* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl,
9192 there are two cases: we are dealing with a BLKmode value
9193 that is returned in a register, or we are dealing with
9194 a promoted value. In the latter case, return a SUBREG
9195 of the wanted mode, but mark it so that we know that it
9196 was already extended. */
9197 if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
9198 && DECL_MODE (exp) != BLKmode
9199 && GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
9201 enum machine_mode pmode;
9203 /* Get the signedness to be used for this variable. Ensure we get
9204 the same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
9205 if (code == SSA_NAME
9206 && (g = SSA_NAME_DEF_STMT (ssa_name))
9207 && gimple_code (g) == GIMPLE_CALL)
9209 gcc_assert (!gimple_call_internal_p (g));
9210 pmode = promote_function_mode (type, mode, &unsignedp,
9211 gimple_call_fntype (g),
9214 else
9215 pmode = promote_decl_mode (exp, &unsignedp);
9216 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
9218 temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
9219 SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
9220 SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
9221 return temp;
9224 return decl_rtl;
9226 case INTEGER_CST:
9227 temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
9228 TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
9230 return temp;
9232 case VECTOR_CST:
9234 tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
9235 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
9236 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT
9237 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FRACT
9238 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UFRACT
9239 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_ACCUM
9240 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_UACCUM)
9241 return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
9242 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
9244 tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
9245 if (type_for_mode)
9246 tmp = fold_unary_loc (loc, VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
9248 if (!tmp)
9249 tmp = build_constructor_from_list (type,
9250 TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp));
9251 return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
9252 tmode, modifier);
9255 case CONST_DECL:
9256 return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
9258 case REAL_CST:
9259 /* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
9260 which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
9262 We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
9263 this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
9264 the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
9265 On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
9266 many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
9268 Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
9269 return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
9270 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9272 case FIXED_CST:
9273 return CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (exp),
9274 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9276 case COMPLEX_CST:
9277 /* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
9278 if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
9280 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9281 rtx rtarg, itarg;
9283 rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
9284 itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
9286 /* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
9287 op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9288 op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9290 if (op0 != rtarg)
9291 emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
9292 if (op1 != itarg)
9293 emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
9295 return original_target;
9298 /* ... fall through ... */
9300 case STRING_CST:
9301 temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
9303 /* temp contains a constant address.
9304 On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
9305 make some insns to get that address into a register. */
9306 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9307 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9308 && modifier != EXPAND_SUM
9309 && ! memory_address_addr_space_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0),
9310 MEM_ADDR_SPACE (temp)))
9311 return replace_equiv_address (temp,
9312 copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
9313 return temp;
9315 case SAVE_EXPR:
9317 tree val = treeop0;
9318 rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
9320 if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
9322 /* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
9323 expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
9324 something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
9325 with non-BLKmode values. */
9326 gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
9328 val = build_decl (EXPR_LOCATION (exp),
9329 VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
9330 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
9331 DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
9332 treeop0 = val;
9333 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = treeop0;
9334 SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
9336 if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
9337 ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
9338 SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
9341 return ret;
9345 case CONSTRUCTOR:
9346 /* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
9347 subexpressions. */
9348 if (ignore)
9350 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9351 tree value;
9353 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
9354 expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
9356 return const0_rtx;
9359 return expand_constructor (exp, target, modifier, false);
9361 case TARGET_MEM_REF:
9363 addr_space_t as
9364 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9365 struct mem_address addr;
9366 enum insn_code icode;
9367 unsigned int align;
9369 get_address_description (exp, &addr);
9370 op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, as, true);
9371 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9372 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9373 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9374 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9375 align = get_object_or_type_alignment (exp);
9376 if (mode != BLKmode
9377 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9378 /* If the target does not have special handling for unaligned
9379 loads of mode then it can use regular moves for them. */
9380 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9381 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9383 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9385 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9386 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9387 nor can the generator. */
9388 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9389 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9390 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9391 return ops[0].value;
9393 return temp;
9396 case MEM_REF:
9398 addr_space_t as
9399 = TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
9400 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9401 tree base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9402 gimple def_stmt;
9403 enum insn_code icode;
9404 unsigned align;
9405 /* Handle expansion of non-aliased memory with non-BLKmode. That
9406 might end up in a register. */
9407 if (mem_ref_refers_to_non_mem_p (exp))
9409 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = mem_ref_offset (exp).low;
9410 tree bit_offset;
9411 tree bftype;
9412 base = TREE_OPERAND (base, 0);
9413 if (offset == 0
9414 && host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), 1)
9415 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (base))
9416 == TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
9417 return expand_expr (build1 (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR,
9418 TREE_TYPE (exp), base),
9419 target, tmode, modifier);
9420 bit_offset = bitsize_int (offset * BITS_PER_UNIT);
9421 bftype = TREE_TYPE (base);
9422 if (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != BLKmode)
9423 bftype = TREE_TYPE (exp);
9424 else
9426 temp = assign_stack_temp (DECL_MODE (base),
9427 GET_MODE_SIZE (DECL_MODE (base)),
9429 store_expr (base, temp, 0, false);
9430 temp = adjust_address (temp, BLKmode, offset);
9431 set_mem_size (temp, int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
9432 return temp;
9434 return expand_expr (build3 (BIT_FIELD_REF, bftype,
9435 base,
9436 TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9437 bit_offset),
9438 target, tmode, modifier);
9440 address_mode = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (as);
9441 base = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
9442 if ((def_stmt = get_def_for_expr (base, BIT_AND_EXPR)))
9444 tree mask = gimple_assign_rhs2 (def_stmt);
9445 base = build2 (BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (base),
9446 gimple_assign_rhs1 (def_stmt), mask);
9447 TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = base;
9449 align = get_object_or_type_alignment (exp);
9450 op0 = expand_expr (base, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
9451 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (address_mode, op0, as);
9452 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
9454 rtx off
9455 = immed_double_int_const (mem_ref_offset (exp), address_mode);
9456 op0 = simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, address_mode, op0, off);
9458 op0 = memory_address_addr_space (mode, op0, as);
9459 temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
9460 set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
9461 set_mem_addr_space (temp, as);
9462 if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
9463 MEM_VOLATILE_P (temp) = 1;
9464 if (mode != BLKmode
9465 && align < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9466 /* If the target does not have special handling for unaligned
9467 loads of mode then it can use regular moves for them. */
9468 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
9469 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
9471 struct expand_operand ops[2];
9473 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
9474 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail,
9475 nor can the generator. */
9476 create_output_operand (&ops[0], NULL_RTX, mode);
9477 create_fixed_operand (&ops[1], temp);
9478 expand_insn (icode, 2, ops);
9479 return ops[0].value;
9481 return temp;
9484 case ARRAY_REF:
9487 tree array = treeop0;
9488 tree index = treeop1;
9490 /* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
9491 This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
9492 Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
9493 difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
9495 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9496 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9497 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
9499 tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
9501 if (t)
9502 return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
9505 /* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
9506 just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
9507 we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
9508 that was declared const. */
9510 if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9511 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9512 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9513 && TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
9514 && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9515 && TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9517 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9518 tree field, value;
9520 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
9521 field, value)
9522 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9524 if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9525 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
9526 break;
9530 else if (optimize >= 1
9531 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9532 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9533 && modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
9534 && TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
9535 && TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
9536 && TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
9537 && const_value_known_p (array))
9539 if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
9541 tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
9543 if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9545 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
9546 tree field, value;
9548 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
9549 field, value)
9550 if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
9552 if (TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
9553 break;
9555 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9557 /* If VALUE is a CONSTRUCTOR, this
9558 optimization is only useful if
9559 this doesn't store the CONSTRUCTOR
9560 into memory. If it does, it is more
9561 efficient to just load the data from
9562 the array directly. */
9563 rtx ret = expand_constructor (value, target,
9564 modifier, true);
9565 if (ret == NULL_RTX)
9566 break;
9569 return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode,
9570 modifier);
9573 else if(TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
9575 tree index1 = index;
9576 tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
9577 index1 = fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9578 treeop1);
9580 /* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
9582 We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
9583 with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
9584 and its mode is QI. Without the conversion,l (ARRAY
9585 +(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
9586 +INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Opps!) */
9588 if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
9589 index1 = size_diffop_loc (loc, index1,
9590 fold_convert_loc (loc, sizetype,
9591 low_bound));
9593 if (0 > compare_tree_int (index1,
9594 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
9596 tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
9597 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
9599 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
9600 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
9601 return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
9602 [TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
9603 mode);
9609 goto normal_inner_ref;
9611 case COMPONENT_REF:
9612 /* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
9613 appropriate field if it is present. */
9614 if (TREE_CODE (treeop0) == CONSTRUCTOR)
9616 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
9617 tree field, value;
9619 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (treeop0),
9620 idx, field, value)
9621 if (field == treeop1
9622 /* We can normally use the value of the field in the
9623 CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
9624 an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
9625 we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
9626 since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
9627 the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
9628 we can't do this optimization. */
9629 && (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9630 || ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
9631 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (DECL_MODE (field))
9632 <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
9634 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
9635 && modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9636 target = 0;
9637 op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
9638 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
9640 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
9641 enum machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
9643 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
9645 op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
9646 op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
9648 else
9650 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (imode) - bitsize;
9652 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9653 target, 0);
9654 op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
9655 target, 0);
9659 return op0;
9662 goto normal_inner_ref;
9664 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9665 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9666 normal_inner_ref:
9668 enum machine_mode mode1, mode2;
9669 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
9670 tree offset;
9671 int volatilep = 0, must_force_mem;
9672 bool packedp = false;
9673 tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
9674 &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
9675 rtx orig_op0, memloc;
9677 /* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
9678 we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
9679 infinitely recurse. */
9680 gcc_assert (tem != exp);
9682 if (TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
9683 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == FIELD_DECL
9684 && DECL_PACKED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
9685 packedp = true;
9687 /* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
9688 computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
9689 to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
9690 orig_op0 = op0
9691 = expand_expr (tem,
9692 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
9693 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
9694 != INTEGER_CST)
9695 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9696 ? target : NULL_RTX),
9697 VOIDmode,
9698 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
9699 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9700 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
9701 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
9704 /* If the bitfield is volatile, we want to access it in the
9705 field's mode, not the computed mode.
9706 If a MEM has VOIDmode (external with incomplete type),
9707 use BLKmode for it instead. */
9708 if (MEM_P (op0))
9710 if (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0)
9711 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, 0);
9712 else if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
9713 op0 = adjust_address (op0, BLKmode, 0);
9716 mode2
9717 = CONSTANT_P (op0) ? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) : GET_MODE (op0);
9719 /* If we have either an offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference
9720 outside the underlying object, we must force it to memory.
9721 Such a case can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
9722 of an expression from a scalar type to an aggregate type or
9723 for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode, or if we were
9724 passed a partially uninitialized object or a view-conversion
9725 to a larger size. */
9726 must_force_mem = (offset
9727 || mode1 == BLKmode
9728 || bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode2));
9730 /* Handle CONCAT first. */
9731 if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT && !must_force_mem)
9733 if (bitpos == 0
9734 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9735 return op0;
9736 if (bitpos == 0
9737 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9738 && bitsize)
9740 op0 = XEXP (op0, 0);
9741 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9743 else if (bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9744 && bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 1)))
9745 && bitpos
9746 && bitsize)
9748 op0 = XEXP (op0, 1);
9749 bitpos = 0;
9750 mode2 = GET_MODE (op0);
9752 else
9753 /* Otherwise force into memory. */
9754 must_force_mem = 1;
9757 /* If this is a constant, put it in a register if it is a legitimate
9758 constant and we don't need a memory reference. */
9759 if (CONSTANT_P (op0)
9760 && mode2 != BLKmode
9761 && targetm.legitimate_constant_p (mode2, op0)
9762 && !must_force_mem)
9763 op0 = force_reg (mode2, op0);
9765 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant, try to force it to the constant
9766 pool. Note that back-ends, e.g. MIPS, may refuse to do so if it
9767 is a legitimate constant. */
9768 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) && (memloc = force_const_mem (mode2, op0)))
9769 op0 = validize_mem (memloc);
9771 /* Otherwise, if this is a constant or the object is not in memory
9772 and need be, put it there. */
9773 else if (CONSTANT_P (op0) || (!MEM_P (op0) && must_force_mem))
9775 tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
9776 (TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
9777 | TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
9778 memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1, 1);
9779 emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
9780 op0 = memloc;
9783 if (offset)
9785 enum machine_mode address_mode;
9786 rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
9787 EXPAND_SUM);
9789 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
9791 address_mode
9792 = targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (op0));
9793 if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != address_mode)
9794 offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (address_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
9796 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
9797 /* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
9798 not try to call force_reg in that case. */
9799 && GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
9800 && bitsize != 0
9801 && (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
9802 && (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
9803 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
9805 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9806 bitpos = 0;
9809 op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
9810 highest_pow2_factor (offset));
9813 /* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
9814 record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
9815 if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
9816 && is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
9817 set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
9819 /* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
9820 if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
9822 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9823 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9825 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
9828 /* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
9829 as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
9830 an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
9831 by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
9832 (which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
9833 storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
9834 if (mode1 == VOIDmode
9835 || REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
9836 || (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
9837 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
9838 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
9839 && modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9840 && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9841 /* If the field is volatile, we always want an aligned
9842 access. Do this in following two situations:
9843 1. the access is not already naturally
9844 aligned, otherwise "normal" (non-bitfield) volatile fields
9845 become non-addressable.
9846 2. the bitsize is narrower than the access size. Need
9847 to extract bitfields from the access. */
9848 || (volatilep && flag_strict_volatile_bitfields > 0
9849 && (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0
9850 || (mode1 != BLKmode
9851 && bitsize < GET_MODE_SIZE (mode1) * BITS_PER_UNIT)))
9852 /* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
9853 fetch it as a bit field. */
9854 || (mode1 != BLKmode
9855 && (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
9856 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
9857 || (MEM_P (op0)
9858 && (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
9859 || (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
9860 && ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9861 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9862 ? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
9863 : SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
9864 || (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
9865 /* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
9866 size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
9867 we must use bitfield operations. */
9868 || (bitsize >= 0
9869 && TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
9870 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
9871 && 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
9872 bitsize)))
9874 enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
9876 if (ext_mode == BLKmode
9877 && ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
9878 && MEM_P (target)
9879 && bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
9880 ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
9882 if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
9884 if (target == 0)
9885 target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
9887 if (bitsize == 0)
9888 return target;
9890 /* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
9891 TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
9892 gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
9893 && (!target || MEM_P (target))
9894 && !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
9896 emit_block_move (target,
9897 adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
9898 bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
9899 GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
9900 / BITS_PER_UNIT),
9901 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9902 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
9904 return target;
9907 op0 = validize_mem (op0);
9909 if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9910 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
9912 op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp, packedp,
9913 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
9914 ? NULL_RTX : target),
9915 ext_mode, ext_mode);
9917 /* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
9918 the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
9919 machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
9920 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
9921 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
9922 && bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
9923 op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
9924 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
9925 - bitsize, op0, 1);
9927 /* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
9928 of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
9929 mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
9930 this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
9931 but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
9932 COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
9933 will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
9934 necessarily be constant. */
9935 if (mode == BLKmode)
9937 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode);
9938 rtx new_rtx;
9940 /* If the reference doesn't use the alias set of its type,
9941 we cannot create the temporary using that type. */
9942 if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (exp))
9944 new_rtx = assign_stack_local (ext_mode, size, 0);
9945 set_mem_alias_set (new_rtx, get_alias_set (exp));
9947 else
9948 new_rtx = assign_stack_temp_for_type (ext_mode, size, 0, type);
9950 emit_move_insn (new_rtx, op0);
9951 op0 = copy_rtx (new_rtx);
9952 PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
9953 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 1);
9956 return op0;
9959 /* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
9960 now as well. */
9961 if (mode == BLKmode)
9962 mode1 = BLKmode;
9964 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
9965 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9966 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9967 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9968 else
9969 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
9971 if (op0 == orig_op0)
9972 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
9974 set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
9975 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
9976 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
9978 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
9979 if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
9980 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
9981 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
9982 return op0;
9983 else if (target == 0)
9984 target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
9986 convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
9987 return target;
9990 case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
9991 return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
9993 case CALL_EXPR:
9994 /* All valid uses of __builtin_va_arg_pack () are removed during
9995 inlining. */
9996 if (CALL_EXPR_VA_ARG_PACK (exp))
9997 error ("%Kinvalid use of %<__builtin_va_arg_pack ()%>", exp);
9999 tree fndecl = get_callee_fndecl (exp), attr;
10001 if (fndecl
10002 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("error",
10003 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10004 error ("%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute error: %s",
10005 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10006 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10007 if (fndecl
10008 && (attr = lookup_attribute ("warning",
10009 DECL_ATTRIBUTES (fndecl))) != NULL)
10010 warning_at (tree_nonartificial_location (exp),
10011 0, "%Kcall to %qs declared with attribute warning: %s",
10012 exp, identifier_to_locale (lang_hooks.decl_printable_name (fndecl, 1)),
10013 TREE_STRING_POINTER (TREE_VALUE (TREE_VALUE (attr))));
10015 /* Check for a built-in function. */
10016 if (fndecl && DECL_BUILT_IN (fndecl))
10018 gcc_assert (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (fndecl) != BUILT_IN_FRONTEND);
10019 return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
10022 return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
10024 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10025 op0 = NULL_RTX;
10027 /* If we are converting to BLKmode, try to avoid an intermediate
10028 temporary by fetching an inner memory reference. */
10029 if (mode == BLKmode
10030 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
10031 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)) != BLKmode
10032 && handled_component_p (treeop0))
10034 enum machine_mode mode1;
10035 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
10036 tree offset;
10037 int unsignedp;
10038 int volatilep = 0;
10039 tree tem
10040 = get_inner_reference (treeop0, &bitsize, &bitpos,
10041 &offset, &mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep,
10042 true);
10043 rtx orig_op0;
10045 /* ??? We should work harder and deal with non-zero offsets. */
10046 if (!offset
10047 && (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0
10048 && bitsize >= 0
10049 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) == 0)
10051 /* See the normal_inner_ref case for the rationale. */
10052 orig_op0
10053 = expand_expr (tem,
10054 (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
10055 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
10056 != INTEGER_CST)
10057 && modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10058 ? target : NULL_RTX),
10059 VOIDmode,
10060 (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
10061 || modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10062 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
10063 ? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
10065 if (MEM_P (orig_op0))
10067 op0 = orig_op0;
10069 /* Get a reference to just this component. */
10070 if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
10071 || modifier == EXPAND_SUM
10072 || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
10073 op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10074 else
10075 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
10077 if (op0 == orig_op0)
10078 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10080 set_mem_attributes (op0, treeop0, 0);
10081 if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
10082 mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
10084 MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
10089 if (!op0)
10090 op0 = expand_expr (treeop0,
10091 NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
10093 /* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
10094 if (mode == GET_MODE (op0))
10096 /* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
10097 then we can use gen_lowpart. */
10098 else if (mode != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
10099 && (GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode)
10100 == GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (op0)))
10101 && !COMPLEX_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0)))
10103 if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
10104 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10105 temp = gen_lowpart_common (mode, op0);
10106 if (temp)
10107 op0 = temp;
10108 else
10110 if (!REG_P (op0) && !MEM_P (op0))
10111 op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
10112 op0 = gen_lowpart (mode, op0);
10115 /* If both types are integral, convert from one mode to the other. */
10116 else if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)))
10117 op0 = convert_modes (mode, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
10118 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (treeop0)));
10119 /* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
10120 different mode. */
10121 else if (!MEM_P (op0))
10123 /* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
10124 are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
10125 force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
10126 constants to change mode. */
10127 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10129 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10131 if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
10132 target
10133 = assign_stack_temp_for_type
10134 (TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
10135 GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), 0, inner_type);
10137 emit_move_insn (target, op0);
10138 op0 = target;
10141 /* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is
10142 such that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
10143 Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
10144 results. */
10145 if (MEM_P (op0))
10147 enum insn_code icode;
10149 op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
10151 if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
10152 set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
10153 else if (mode != BLKmode
10154 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
10155 /* If the target does have special handling for unaligned
10156 loads of mode then use them. */
10157 && ((icode = optab_handler (movmisalign_optab, mode))
10158 != CODE_FOR_nothing))
10160 rtx reg, insn;
10162 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10163 /* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
10164 new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't
10165 fail. */
10166 reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10168 /* Nor can the insn generator. */
10169 insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, op0);
10170 emit_insn (insn);
10171 return reg;
10173 else if (STRICT_ALIGNMENT
10174 && mode != BLKmode
10175 && MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
10177 tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (treeop0);
10178 HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
10179 = MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
10180 (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
10181 rtx new_rtx
10182 = assign_stack_temp_for_type (mode, temp_size, 0, type);
10183 rtx new_with_op0_mode
10184 = adjust_address (new_rtx, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
10186 gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
10188 if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
10189 emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
10190 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
10191 (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
10192 ? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
10193 else
10194 emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
10196 op0 = new_rtx;
10199 op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode, 0);
10202 return op0;
10204 case MODIFY_EXPR:
10206 tree lhs = treeop0;
10207 tree rhs = treeop1;
10208 gcc_assert (ignore);
10210 /* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
10211 of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
10212 assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
10213 test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
10215 ??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
10216 things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
10217 support it. */
10218 if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
10219 && (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
10220 || TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
10221 && TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
10222 && TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
10223 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
10224 && integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
10226 rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
10227 int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
10228 do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
10229 value ? label : 0,
10230 value ? 0 : label, -1);
10231 expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value),
10232 MOVE_NONTEMPORAL (exp));
10233 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10234 emit_label (label);
10235 return const0_rtx;
10238 expand_assignment (lhs, rhs, MOVE_NONTEMPORAL (exp));
10239 return const0_rtx;
10242 case ADDR_EXPR:
10243 return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
10245 case REALPART_EXPR:
10246 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10247 return read_complex_part (op0, false);
10249 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
10250 op0 = expand_normal (treeop0);
10251 return read_complex_part (op0, true);
10253 case RETURN_EXPR:
10254 case LABEL_EXPR:
10255 case GOTO_EXPR:
10256 case SWITCH_EXPR:
10257 case ASM_EXPR:
10258 /* Expanded in cfgexpand.c. */
10259 gcc_unreachable ();
10261 case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
10262 case CATCH_EXPR:
10263 case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
10264 case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
10265 /* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
10266 gcc_unreachable ();
10268 case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
10269 case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
10270 case TARGET_EXPR:
10271 case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
10272 case VA_ARG_EXPR:
10273 case BIND_EXPR:
10274 case INIT_EXPR:
10275 case CONJ_EXPR:
10276 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
10277 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
10278 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
10279 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
10280 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
10281 case LOOP_EXPR:
10282 case EXIT_EXPR:
10283 /* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
10284 gcc_unreachable ();
10286 case FDESC_EXPR:
10287 /* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
10288 initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
10289 gcc_unreachable ();
10291 case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
10292 /* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
10293 have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
10294 return expand_expr_real (treeop0, original_target, tmode,
10295 modifier, alt_rtl);
10297 case COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR:
10299 /* Initialize the anonymous variable declared in the compound
10300 literal, then return the variable. */
10301 tree decl = COMPOUND_LITERAL_EXPR_DECL (exp);
10303 /* Create RTL for this variable. */
10304 if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl))
10306 if (DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl))
10307 /* The user specified an assembler name for this variable.
10308 Set that up now. */
10309 rest_of_decl_compilation (decl, 0, 0);
10310 else
10311 expand_decl (decl);
10314 return expand_expr_real (decl, original_target, tmode,
10315 modifier, alt_rtl);
10318 default:
10319 return expand_expr_real_2 (&ops, target, tmode, modifier);
10323 /* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
10324 signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
10325 static rtx
10326 reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
10328 HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
10329 if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
10330 target = 0;
10331 /* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
10332 if (CONST_INT_P (exp))
10334 HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
10335 tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
10336 return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10338 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
10340 rtx mask = immed_double_int_const (double_int_mask (prec),
10341 GET_MODE (exp));
10342 return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
10344 else
10346 int count = GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec;
10347 exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10348 exp, count, target, 0);
10349 return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp),
10350 exp, count, target, 0);
10354 /* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
10355 when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
10356 aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10358 static int
10359 is_aligning_offset (const_tree offset, const_tree exp)
10361 /* Strip off any conversions. */
10362 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10363 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10365 /* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
10366 power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
10367 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
10368 || !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
10369 || compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
10370 BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
10371 || !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
10372 return 0;
10374 /* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
10375 It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
10376 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10377 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10378 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10380 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
10381 return 0;
10383 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10384 while (CONVERT_EXPR_P (offset))
10385 offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
10387 /* This must now be the address of EXP. */
10388 return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
10391 /* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
10392 if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
10393 in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
10394 offset will be `sizetype'. */
10396 tree
10397 string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
10399 tree array, offset, lower_bound;
10400 STRIP_NOPS (arg);
10402 if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
10404 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
10406 *ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
10407 return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10409 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
10411 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10412 offset = size_zero_node;
10414 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
10416 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10417 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10418 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10419 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10420 return 0;
10422 /* Check if the array has a nonzero lower bound. */
10423 lower_bound = array_ref_low_bound (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0));
10424 if (!integer_zerop (lower_bound))
10426 /* If the offset and base aren't both constants, return 0. */
10427 if (TREE_CODE (lower_bound) != INTEGER_CST)
10428 return 0;
10429 if (TREE_CODE (offset) != INTEGER_CST)
10430 return 0;
10431 /* Adjust offset by the lower bound. */
10432 offset = size_diffop (fold_convert (sizetype, offset),
10433 fold_convert (sizetype, lower_bound));
10436 else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == MEM_REF)
10438 array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
10439 offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
10440 if (TREE_CODE (array) != ADDR_EXPR)
10441 return 0;
10442 array = TREE_OPERAND (array, 0);
10443 if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
10444 && TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
10445 return 0;
10447 else
10448 return 0;
10450 else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR || TREE_CODE (arg) == POINTER_PLUS_EXPR)
10452 tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
10453 tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
10455 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10456 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10458 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
10459 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
10460 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10462 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
10463 offset = arg1;
10465 else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
10466 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
10467 || TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
10469 array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
10470 offset = arg0;
10472 else
10473 return 0;
10475 else
10476 return 0;
10478 if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
10480 *ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10481 return array;
10483 else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL
10484 || TREE_CODE (array) == CONST_DECL)
10486 int length;
10488 /* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
10489 if (!const_value_known_p (array)
10490 || !DECL_INITIAL (array)
10491 || TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != STRING_CST)
10492 return 0;
10494 /* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
10495 if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
10496 || TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
10497 || (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (DECL_INITIAL (array))) <= 0
10498 || compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
10499 return 0;
10501 /* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
10502 and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
10503 offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
10504 if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
10505 && (! host_integerp (offset, 1)
10506 || compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
10507 return 0;
10509 *ptr_offset = offset;
10510 return DECL_INITIAL (array);
10513 return 0;
10516 /* Generate code to calculate OPS, and exploded expression
10517 using a store-flag instruction and return an rtx for the result.
10518 OPS reflects a comparison.
10520 If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
10522 Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
10523 available on this machine.
10525 Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
10526 we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
10527 re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
10528 emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
10529 to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
10530 it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
10531 set/jump/set sequence. */
10533 static rtx
10534 do_store_flag (sepops ops, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode)
10536 enum rtx_code code;
10537 tree arg0, arg1, type;
10538 tree tem;
10539 enum machine_mode operand_mode;
10540 int unsignedp;
10541 rtx op0, op1;
10542 rtx subtarget = target;
10543 location_t loc = ops->location;
10545 arg0 = ops->op0;
10546 arg1 = ops->op1;
10548 /* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
10549 if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
10550 return const0_rtx;
10552 type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
10553 operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
10554 unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
10556 /* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
10557 passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
10558 if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
10559 return 0;
10561 /* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
10562 when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
10563 #ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10564 if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
10565 && ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)) == POINTER_TYPE
10566 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg0)))
10567 == FUNCTION_TYPE))
10568 || (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)) == POINTER_TYPE
10569 && (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (arg1)))
10570 == FUNCTION_TYPE))))
10571 return 0;
10572 #endif
10574 STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
10575 STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
10577 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
10578 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
10579 expander for this. */
10580 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10582 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
10583 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
10584 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
10585 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true, if_false, target);
10588 /* For vector typed comparisons emit code to generate the desired
10589 all-ones or all-zeros mask. Conveniently use the VEC_COND_EXPR
10590 expander for this. */
10591 if (TREE_CODE (ops->type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10593 tree ifexp = build2 (ops->code, ops->type, arg0, arg1);
10594 tree if_true = constant_boolean_node (true, ops->type);
10595 tree if_false = constant_boolean_node (false, ops->type);
10596 return expand_vec_cond_expr (ops->type, ifexp, if_true, if_false, target);
10599 /* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
10600 operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
10601 converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
10602 below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
10603 tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
10604 are rarely passed as the first operand. */
10606 switch (ops->code)
10608 case EQ_EXPR:
10609 code = EQ;
10610 break;
10611 case NE_EXPR:
10612 code = NE;
10613 break;
10614 case LT_EXPR:
10615 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10616 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10617 else
10618 code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
10619 break;
10620 case LE_EXPR:
10621 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10622 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
10623 else
10624 code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
10625 break;
10626 case GT_EXPR:
10627 if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
10628 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
10629 else
10630 code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10631 break;
10632 case GE_EXPR:
10633 if (integer_onep (arg1))
10634 arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
10635 else
10636 code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
10637 break;
10639 case UNORDERED_EXPR:
10640 code = UNORDERED;
10641 break;
10642 case ORDERED_EXPR:
10643 code = ORDERED;
10644 break;
10645 case UNLT_EXPR:
10646 code = UNLT;
10647 break;
10648 case UNLE_EXPR:
10649 code = UNLE;
10650 break;
10651 case UNGT_EXPR:
10652 code = UNGT;
10653 break;
10654 case UNGE_EXPR:
10655 code = UNGE;
10656 break;
10657 case UNEQ_EXPR:
10658 code = UNEQ;
10659 break;
10660 case LTGT_EXPR:
10661 code = LTGT;
10662 break;
10664 default:
10665 gcc_unreachable ();
10668 /* Put a constant second. */
10669 if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST
10670 || TREE_CODE (arg0) == FIXED_CST)
10672 tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
10673 code = swap_condition (code);
10676 /* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
10677 do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
10678 masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
10679 we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
10680 than an scc insn even if we have it.
10682 The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
10683 so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
10685 if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
10686 && integer_zerop (arg1)
10687 && (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) != 1 || TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)))
10689 gimple srcstmt = get_def_for_expr (arg0, BIT_AND_EXPR);
10690 if (srcstmt
10691 && integer_pow2p (gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt)))
10693 enum tree_code tcode = code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR;
10694 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
10695 tree temp = fold_build2_loc (loc, BIT_AND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (arg1),
10696 gimple_assign_rhs1 (srcstmt),
10697 gimple_assign_rhs2 (srcstmt));
10698 temp = fold_single_bit_test (loc, tcode, temp, arg1, type);
10699 if (temp)
10700 return expand_expr (temp, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10704 if (! get_subtarget (target)
10705 || GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
10706 subtarget = 0;
10708 expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
10710 if (target == 0)
10711 target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
10713 /* Try a cstore if possible. */
10714 return emit_store_flag_force (target, code, op0, op1,
10715 operand_mode, unsignedp,
10716 (TYPE_PRECISION (ops->type) == 1
10717 && !TYPE_UNSIGNED (ops->type)) ? -1 : 1);
10721 /* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
10722 #ifndef HAVE_casesi
10723 # define HAVE_casesi 0
10724 # define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
10725 # define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
10726 #endif
10728 /* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
10729 0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
10731 try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10732 rtx table_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx default_label,
10733 rtx fallback_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10735 struct expand_operand ops[5];
10736 enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
10737 rtx op1, op2, index;
10739 if (! HAVE_casesi)
10740 return 0;
10742 /* Convert the index to SImode. */
10743 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
10745 enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
10746 rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
10748 /* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
10749 index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10750 index_expr, minval);
10751 minval = integer_zero_node;
10752 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10753 if (default_label)
10754 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
10755 omode, 1, default_label);
10756 /* Now we can safely truncate. */
10757 index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
10759 else
10761 if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
10763 index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (index_mode, 0);
10764 index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
10767 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10770 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10772 op1 = expand_normal (minval);
10773 op2 = expand_normal (range);
10775 create_input_operand (&ops[0], index, index_mode);
10776 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[1], op1, TREE_TYPE (minval));
10777 create_convert_operand_from_type (&ops[2], op2, TREE_TYPE (range));
10778 create_fixed_operand (&ops[3], table_label);
10779 create_fixed_operand (&ops[4], (default_label
10780 ? default_label
10781 : fallback_label));
10782 expand_jump_insn (CODE_FOR_casesi, 5, ops);
10783 return 1;
10786 /* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
10787 #ifndef HAVE_tablejump
10788 #define HAVE_tablejump 0
10789 #define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
10790 #endif
10792 /* Subroutine of the next function.
10794 INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
10795 in the table already subtracted.
10796 MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
10797 RANGE is the length of the jump table.
10798 TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
10800 DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
10801 index value is out of range. */
10803 static void
10804 do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
10805 rtx default_label)
10807 rtx temp, vector;
10809 if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents)
10810 cfun->cfg->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
10812 /* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
10813 expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
10814 Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
10815 from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
10816 check that the original index expression value is both greater than
10817 or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
10818 the maximum value of the range. */
10820 if (default_label)
10821 emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
10822 default_label);
10824 /* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
10825 Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
10826 if (mode != Pmode)
10827 index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
10829 /* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
10830 out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
10831 and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
10832 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10833 if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
10834 index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
10835 #endif
10837 /* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
10838 GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
10839 uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
10840 could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
10841 index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
10842 gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
10843 GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
10844 gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
10845 #ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
10846 if (flag_pic)
10847 index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
10848 else
10849 #endif
10850 index = memory_address (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10851 temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
10852 vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
10853 convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
10855 emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
10857 /* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
10858 table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
10859 if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
10860 emit_barrier ();
10864 try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
10865 rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
10867 rtx index;
10869 if (! HAVE_tablejump)
10870 return 0;
10872 index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
10873 fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
10874 fold_convert (index_type, minval));
10875 index = expand_normal (index_expr);
10876 do_pending_stack_adjust ();
10878 do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10879 convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
10880 TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
10881 expand_normal (range),
10882 TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
10883 table_label, default_label);
10884 return 1;
10887 /* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
10888 static rtx
10889 const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
10891 rtvec v;
10892 int units, i;
10893 tree link, elt;
10894 enum machine_mode inner, mode;
10896 mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
10898 if (initializer_zerop (exp))
10899 return CONST0_RTX (mode);
10901 units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
10902 inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
10904 v = rtvec_alloc (units);
10906 link = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp);
10907 for (i = 0; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link), ++i)
10909 elt = TREE_VALUE (link);
10911 if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
10912 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
10913 inner);
10914 else if (TREE_CODE (elt) == FIXED_CST)
10915 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_FIXED_FROM_FIXED_VALUE (TREE_FIXED_CST (elt),
10916 inner);
10917 else
10918 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_int_const (tree_to_double_int (elt),
10919 inner);
10922 /* Initialize remaining elements to 0. */
10923 for (; i < units; ++i)
10924 RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST0_RTX (inner);
10926 return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
10929 /* Build a decl for a personality function given a language prefix. */
10931 tree
10932 build_personality_function (const char *lang)
10934 const char *unwind_and_version;
10935 tree decl, type;
10936 char *name;
10938 switch (targetm_common.except_unwind_info (&global_options))
10940 case UI_NONE:
10941 return NULL;
10942 case UI_SJLJ:
10943 unwind_and_version = "_sj0";
10944 break;
10945 case UI_DWARF2:
10946 case UI_TARGET:
10947 unwind_and_version = "_v0";
10948 break;
10949 default:
10950 gcc_unreachable ();
10953 name = ACONCAT (("__", lang, "_personality", unwind_and_version, NULL));
10955 type = build_function_type_list (integer_type_node, integer_type_node,
10956 long_long_unsigned_type_node,
10957 ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node, NULL_TREE);
10958 decl = build_decl (UNKNOWN_LOCATION, FUNCTION_DECL,
10959 get_identifier (name), type);
10960 DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) = 1;
10961 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
10962 TREE_PUBLIC (decl) = 1;
10964 /* Zap the nonsensical SYMBOL_REF_DECL for this. What we're left with
10965 are the flags assigned by targetm.encode_section_info. */
10966 SET_SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0), NULL);
10968 return decl;
10971 /* Extracts the personality function of DECL and returns the corresponding
10972 libfunc. */
10975 get_personality_function (tree decl)
10977 tree personality = DECL_FUNCTION_PERSONALITY (decl);
10978 enum eh_personality_kind pk;
10980 pk = function_needs_eh_personality (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
10981 if (pk == eh_personality_none)
10982 return NULL;
10984 if (!personality
10985 && pk == eh_personality_any)
10986 personality = lang_hooks.eh_personality ();
10988 if (pk == eh_personality_lang)
10989 gcc_assert (personality != NULL_TREE);
10991 return XEXP (DECL_RTL (personality), 0);
10994 #include "gt-expr.h"